blob: bac18ab353f69cbfe83980e2c499d6ad2dfda3a9 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1f973062021-05-14 09:36:37 +02005 version 2.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau08d0f232021-08-17 14:08:55 +02007 2021/08/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001028.2.4. HTTPS log format
1038.2.5. Custom log format
1048.2.6. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001058.3. Advanced logging options
1068.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1078.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1088.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1098.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1108.4. Timing events
1118.5. Session state at disconnection
1128.6. Non-printable characters
1138.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1148.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1158.9. Examples of logs
116
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001179. Supported filters
1189.1. Trace
1199.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001209.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001219.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001229.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001239.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200124
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012510. FastCGI applications
12610.1. Setup
12710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12810.1.2. Proxy section
12910.1.3. Example
13010.2. Default parameters
13110.3. Limitations
132
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013311. Address formats
13411.1. Address family prefixes
13511.2. Socket type prefixes
13611.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137
1381. Quick reminder about HTTP
139----------------------------
140
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100141When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
143on almost anything found in the contents.
144
145However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
146formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
147correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
148
149
1501.1. The HTTP transaction model
151-------------------------------
152
153The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100154to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100155from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
156connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157will involve a new connection :
158
159 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
160
161In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
162establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
163by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
164length.
165
166Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
167to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
168however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
169response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
170header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
171
172 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
173
174Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
175power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
176but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200177a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100179Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
181second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
182page :
183
184 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
185
186This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
187latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
188correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
189the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100190server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
193time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
194are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
195parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
196carry the stream identifier.
197
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
199connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
200leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100201start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
202processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
203waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200204
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200205HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100206 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
207 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100208 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100209 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200210 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100211
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213
2141.2. HTTP request
215-----------------
216
217First, let's consider this HTTP request :
218
219 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100220 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
222 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
223 3 User-agent: my small browser
224 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
225 5 Accept: image/png
226
227
2281.2.1. The Request line
229-----------------------
230
231Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
232
233 - a METHOD : GET
234 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
235 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
236
237All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
238which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
239followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
240is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
241desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
242the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
243
244The URI itself can have several forms :
245
246 - A "relative URI" :
247
248 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
249
250 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
251 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
252
253 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
254
255 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
256
257 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
258 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
259 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
260 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
261 must accept this form too.
262
263 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
264 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
265 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200267 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
268 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
269 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
270 other protocols too.
271
272In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
273mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
274on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
275It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
276specific to the language, framework or application in use.
277
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100278HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100279assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200297as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
298normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
299representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
300HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301
302The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
303that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
304is one valid form of empty line.
305
306Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
307headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
308about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
309application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
310
311Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000312 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
314 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
315 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
316
317
3181.3. HTTP response
319------------------
320
321An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
322messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
323
324 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100325 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
327 2 Content-length: 350
328 3 Content-Type: text/html
329
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
331codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
332response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100333continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
334the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
335following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
336sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
337(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
338correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
339such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
340state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400341over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100342if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
343information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003461.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347------------------------
348
349Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
350
351 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
352 - a status code : 200
353 - a reason : OK
354
355The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100356 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
357 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
358 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
359 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
360 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000362Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100363"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
365messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
366or "Authentication Required".
367
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100368HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200369
370 Code When / reason
371 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
372 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100375 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
376 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377 400 for an invalid or too large request
378 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
379 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100381 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100383 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
384 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400385 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400387 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100388 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200389 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200390 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200391 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
392 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
393 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
394
395The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3964.2).
397
398
3991.3.2. The response headers
400---------------------------
401
402Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
403the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
404details.
405
406
4072. Configuring HAProxy
408----------------------
409
4102.1. Configuration file format
411------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200412
413HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
414
415 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100416 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700417 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100418 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200419
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100420The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
421a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100422
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100423 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
424
425 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
426
427 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
428 tab characters
429
430 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
431 keyword sequences listed in this document
432
433 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
434 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
435 parts of the configuration, or expressions
436
437 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
438 are supported
439
440 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
441 section
442
443This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
444generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
445figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
446
447First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
448the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
449a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
450word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
451follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
452the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
453the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
454the parts that need to be addressed.
455
456A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
457requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
458extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
459the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
460section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
461section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
462not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
463
464A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
465each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
466a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
467start a new one.
468
469Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
470that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
471applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
472"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
473processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
474ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
475which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
476In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
477of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
478identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
479such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4802, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
481
482 listen foo
483 bind :80
484
485 listen bar
486 bind :81
487
488Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
489spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
490of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
491following configurations are strictly equivalent:
492
493 global#this is the global section
494 daemon#daemonize
495 frontend foo
496 mode http # or tcp
497
498and:
499
500 global
501 daemon
502
503 # this is the public web frontend
504 frontend foo
505 mode http
506
507The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
508new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
509other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
510section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
511section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
512at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
513
514Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
515are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
516editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
517support automatic indent.
518
519In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
520positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
521modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
522anymore, and is not recommended.
523
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200524
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005252.2. Quoting and escaping
526-------------------------
527
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100528In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
529that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
530possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
531in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
532('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200533
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100534This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
535very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
536the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
537also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
538delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
539word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
540remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200541
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100542If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
543(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
544
545Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
546backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200547
548 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
549 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
550 \\ to use a backslash
551 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
552 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
553
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100554In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
555C-language representation:
556
557 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
558 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
559 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
560 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
561
562Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
563or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
564of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200565
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100566 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200567 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
568 # hash as a comment start
569
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100570Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
571evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
572dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
573backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200574
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100575Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
576character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
577is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200578
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100579As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
580entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
581name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
582represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
583hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200584
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100585 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
586 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
587 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
588 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
589 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
590 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
591 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
592 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
593 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
594 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
595 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200596
597 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100598 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200599 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
600 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
601 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
603 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
604
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100605There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
606necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
607by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
608they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
609escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
610characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
611case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
612if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
613own quotes.
614
615The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
616quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500617not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100618quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
619
620Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
621arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
622
623 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
624 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
625
626Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
627"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
628cannot write:
629
630 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
631
632because we would like the string to cut like this:
633
634 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
635 |---------|----|-|
636 arg1 _/ / /
637 arg2 __________/ /
638 arg3 ______________/
639
640but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
641parenthesis then garbage:
642
643 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
644 |--------|--------|
645 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
646 trailing garbage _________/
647
648The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
649quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
650processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
651this word:
652
653 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
654 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
655 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
656
657So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
658still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
659the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
660the second level:
661
662 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
663 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
664 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
665 |---------||----|-|
666 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
667 arg2=blah ___________/ /
668 arg3=g _______________/
669
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500670Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100671double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
672
673 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
674 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
675 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
676 |---------||----|-|
677 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
678 arg2 ___________/ /
679 arg3 _______________/
680
681When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
682appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
683string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
684thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
685
686 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
687 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
688 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
689 |-------------| |-----||-|
690 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
691 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
692 arg3 ______________________/
693
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400694Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100695that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
696quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
697single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
698level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
699
700When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
701double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
702and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
703a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
704a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
705the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
706regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
707around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
708more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200709
710
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007112.3. Environment variables
712--------------------------
713
714HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
715interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
716configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
717optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
718shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200719underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
720list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
721arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
722before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200723
724 Example:
725
726 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
727
728 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
729
730 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
731
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200732Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
733file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200734
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200735* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
736 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
737
738* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
739 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
740 directory.
741
742* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
743
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500744* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200745 processes, separated by semicolons.
746
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500747* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200748 CLI, separated by semicolons.
749
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200750In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
751regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
752only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
753
754* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
755
756* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
757 starting at one.
758
759* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
760 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
761 first section.
762
763These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
764if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
765section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
766"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
767proxies.
768
769This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
770logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
771to name some config objects like servers for example.
772
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200773See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200774
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100775
7762.4. Conditional blocks
777-----------------------
778
779It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
780some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
781ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
782configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
783versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
784preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
785text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
786lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
787switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
788are defined to form conditional blocks:
789
790 - .if <condition>
791 - .elif <condition>
792 - .else
793 - .endif
794
795The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
796as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
797matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
798there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
799only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
800".elif" of a block.
801
802Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
803ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
804as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
805
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200806Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
807See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
808
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200809The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
810expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100811
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100812 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
813 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200814 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200815 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530816 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
817 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200818 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
819 from left to right until one returns false
820 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
821 from right to left until one returns true
822
823Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
824operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200825
826The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
827
828 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
829 exists, regardless of its contents
830
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200831 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
832 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
833 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
834
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200835 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
836 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
837
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200838 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
839 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
840 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
841 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
842
843 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
844 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
845 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
846 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
847
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200848Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100849
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200850 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
851 listen mwcli_px
852 bind :1111
853 ...
854 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100855
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200856 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
857 bind :80
858 .endif
859
860 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200861 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200862 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200863 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200864 .endif
865
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200866 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200867 bind :443 ssl crt ...
868 .endif
869
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200870 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
871 profiling.memory on
872 .endif
873
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200874 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
875 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
876 .endif
877
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200878Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100879
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200880 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100881 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
882 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
883 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
884
885Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
886"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
887fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
888provide advice to the user.
889
890Example:
891
892 .if "${A}"
893 .if "${B}"
894 .notice "A=1, B=1"
895 .elif "${C}"
896 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
897 .elif "${D}"
898 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
899 .else
900 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
901 .endif
902 .else
903 .notice "A=0"
904 .endif
905
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200906 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
907 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
908
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100909
9102.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200911----------------
912
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100913Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100914values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
915otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
916numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
917for every keyword. Supported units are :
918
919 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
920 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
921 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
922 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
923 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
924 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
925
926
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009272.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200928-------------
929
930 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
931 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
932 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
933 global
934 daemon
935 maxconn 256
936
937 defaults
938 mode http
939 timeout connect 5000ms
940 timeout client 50000ms
941 timeout server 50000ms
942
943 frontend http-in
944 bind *:80
945 default_backend servers
946
947 backend servers
948 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
949
950
951 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
952 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
953 global
954 daemon
955 maxconn 256
956
957 defaults
958 mode http
959 timeout connect 5000ms
960 timeout client 50000ms
961 timeout server 50000ms
962
963 listen http-in
964 bind *:80
965 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
966
967
968Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
969
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100970 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200971
972
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009733. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200974--------------------
975
976Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
977are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
978of them have command-line equivalents.
979
980The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
981
982 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200983 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200984 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200985 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200986 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200987 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200988 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200989 - description
990 - deviceatlas-json-file
991 - deviceatlas-log-level
992 - deviceatlas-separator
993 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +0200994 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900995 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200996 - gid
997 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100998 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200999 - h1-case-adjust
1000 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001001 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001002 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001003 - issuers-chain-path
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001004 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001005 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001007 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001008 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001009 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001010 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001011 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001012 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001013 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001014 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001015 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001016 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001017 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001018 - presetenv
1019 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001020 - uid
1021 - ulimit-n
1022 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001023 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001024 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001025 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001026 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001027 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001028 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001029 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001030 - ssl-default-bind-options
1031 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001032 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001033 - ssl-default-server-options
1034 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001035 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001036 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001037 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001038 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001039 - 51degrees-data-file
1040 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001041 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001042 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001043 - wurfl-data-file
1044 - wurfl-information-list
1045 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001046 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001047 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001048
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001049 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001050 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001051 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001052 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001053 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001054 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001055 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001056 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001057 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001058 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001059 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001060 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001061 - noepoll
1062 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001063 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001064 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001065 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001066 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001067 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001068 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001069 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001070 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001071 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001072 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001073 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001074 - tune.buffers.limit
1075 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001076 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001077 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001078 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001079 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001080 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001081 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001082 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001083 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001084 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001085 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001086 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001087 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001088 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001089 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1090 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001091 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001092 - tune.maxaccept
1093 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001094 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001095 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001096 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001097 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1098 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001099 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1100 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001101 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001102 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001103 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001104 - tune.sndbuf.client
1105 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001106 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001107 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001108 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001109 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001110 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001111 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001112 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02001113 - tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size
1114 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size (deprecated)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001115 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001116 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001117 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1118 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1119 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001120 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1121 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001122
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001123 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001124 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001125 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001126
1127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011283.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001129------------------------------------
1130
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001131ca-base <dir>
1132 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001133 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1134 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1135 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001136
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001137chroot <jail dir>
1138 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1139 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1140 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1141 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1142 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001143 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001144
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001145cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001146 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001147 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1148 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1149 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1150 set. These sets have the format
1151
1152 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1153
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001154 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
1155 word size. Any process IDs above 1 and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001156 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001157 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all thraeds at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001158 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1159 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001160 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1161 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1162 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1163 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1164 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1165 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1166 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1167 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1168 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1169 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001170
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001171 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1172 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1173 on the machine's word size.
1174
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001175 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001176 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing threads and
1177 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1178 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
1179 highest bound. Having both a process and a thread range with the "auto:"
1180 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1181 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001182
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001183 Note that process ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a
1184 lone number designates a process and must be 1, and specifying a thread range
1185 or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of it. Finally, "1" is strictly
1186 equivalent to "1/all" and designates all threads on the process.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001187
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001188 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001189 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1190 # first 4 CPUs
1191
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001192 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1193 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001194 # word size.
1195
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001196 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1197 # and so on.
1198 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1199 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1200 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1201
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001202 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1203 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1204 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1205 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001206
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001207 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1208 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1209 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001210
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001211crt-base <dir>
1212 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001213 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1214 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001215
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001216daemon
1217 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1218 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001219 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1220 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001221
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001222default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001223 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001224 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1225 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1226 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1227 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1228 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1229 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1230 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1231 not start with a slash ('/'):
1232 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1233 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1234
1235 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1236 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1237 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1238 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1239 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1240 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1241 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1242 each of them.
1243
1244 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1245 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1246 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1247 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1248 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1249 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1250 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1251 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1252
1253 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1254 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001255 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001256 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1257 made easily relocatable.
1258
1259 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1260 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1261 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1262 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1263 consistent across all configuration files.
1264
1265 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1266 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1267 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1268 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1269 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1270 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1271 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1272 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1273
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001274deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1275 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001276 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001277
1278deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001279 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001280 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1281
1282deviceatlas-separator <char>
1283 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1284 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1285
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001286deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001287 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1288 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1289 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001290
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001291expose-experimental-directives
1292 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1293 the config file will be rejected.
1294
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001295external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001296 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1297 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001298 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1299 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1300 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1301 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1302 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001303
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001304gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001305 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001306 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1307 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001308 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001309 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001310 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001311
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001312group <group name>
1313 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1314 See also "gid" and "user".
1315
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001316hard-stop-after <time>
1317 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1318
1319 Arguments :
1320 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1321 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1322 SIGUSR1 signal.
1323
1324 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1325 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1326 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1327
1328 Example:
1329 global
1330 hard-stop-after 30s
1331
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001332h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1333 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1334 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1335 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1336 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001337 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001338 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1339 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1340 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1341 specified in a proxy.
1342
1343 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1344 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1345 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1346 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1347 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1348 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1349 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1350
1351 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1352 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1353 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1354 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1355 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1356
1357 Example:
1358 global
1359 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1360
1361 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1362 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1363
1364h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1365 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1366 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1367 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1368 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1369 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1370 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1371 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1372 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1373
1374 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1375 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1376 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1377
1378 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1379 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1380
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001381insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001382 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001383 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1384 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1385 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1386 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1387 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1388 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1389 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001390 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001391 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1392 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1393 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1394 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1395 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1396 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1397 disable it.
1398
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001399insecure-setuid-wanted
1400 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1401 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1402 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1403 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001404 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001405 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001406 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001407 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1408 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001409 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001410 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1411 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1412 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1413 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1414
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001415issuers-chain-path <dir>
1416 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1417 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1418 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001419 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001420 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1421 "issuers-chain-path".
1422 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1423 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1424 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1425 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1426 will share the chain in memory.
1427
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001428h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1429 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1430 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1431 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1432 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1433 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1434 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1435 the keyword with "no'.
1436
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001437localpeer <name>
1438 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1439 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1440 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1441 the configuration parsing.
1442
1443 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1444 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1445
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001446log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001447 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001448 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001449 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001450 configured with "log global".
1451
1452 <address> can be one of:
1453
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001454 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001455 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1456 port).
1457
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001458 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1459 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1460 port).
1461
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001462 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001463 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1464 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001465 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001466
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001467 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1468 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1469 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1470 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1471 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1472 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1473 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1474 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1475 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1476 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001477 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001478 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1479 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1480 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001481 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1482 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001483
1484 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1485 "fd@2", see above.
1486
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001487 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1488 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1489 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1490 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1491 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1492
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001493 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1494 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001495
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001496 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1497 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1498 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1499 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1500 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1501 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1502 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1503 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1504 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1505 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001506 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1507 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001508
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001509 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1510 one of the following :
1511
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001512 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1513 field is stripped. This is the default.
1514 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1515 rfc3164.
1516
1517 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001518 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1519
1520 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1521 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1522
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001523 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1524 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1525 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1526 designed to be used with a local log server.
1527
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001528 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1529 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1530 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1531 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1532 logger consumes.
1533
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001534 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1535 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1536 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1537 used with a local log server.
1538
1539 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1540 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1541 designed to be used with a local log server.
1542
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001543 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1544 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1545 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1546 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1547
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001548 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1549 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1550 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1551 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1552 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1553
1554 <sample_size>
1555 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1556 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1557 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1558 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1559 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1560
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001561 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001562
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001563 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1564 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1565 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1566
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001567 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1568 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1569 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1570 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001571
1572 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001573 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1574 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1575 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1576 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1577 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1578 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001579
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001580 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001581
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001582log-send-hostname [<string>]
1583 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1584 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1585 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1586 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1587 the logs.
1588
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001589log-tag <string>
1590 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1591 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1592 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001593 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001594
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001595lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001596 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1597 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1598 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1599 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1600 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1601 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001602 used multiple times.
1603
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001604lua-load-per-thread <file>
1605 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1606 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1607 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1608 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1609 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1610 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1611 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1612 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1613 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1614 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1615 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1616 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1617 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1618 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1619 times.
1620
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001621lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1622 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1623 variable.
1624 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1625 to "path".
1626
1627 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1628 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1629 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1630 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1631 will be checked earlier.
1632
1633 As an example by specifying the following path:
1634
1635 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1636 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1637
1638 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1639 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1640 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1641 paths if that does not exist either.
1642
1643 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1644 documentation.
1645
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001646master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001647 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1648 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1649 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001650 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001651 or daemon mode.
1652
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001653 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1654 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1655 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1656 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1657 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001658
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001659 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001660
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001661mworker-max-reloads <number>
1662 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001663 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001664 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1665 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1666 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1667
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001668nbthread <number>
1669 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02001670 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
1671 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
1672 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
1673 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
1674 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
1675 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
1676 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001677
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001678numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001679 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001680 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1681 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1682 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1683 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1684 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1685 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1686 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1687 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1688
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001689pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001690 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1691 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1692 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1693 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001694
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001695pp2-never-send-local
1696 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1697 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1698 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1699 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1700 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1701 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1702 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1703 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1704 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1705 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1706 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1707
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001708presetenv <name> <value>
1709 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1710 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1711 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1712 and "unsetenv".
1713
1714resetenv [<name> ...]
1715 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1716 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1717 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1718 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1719 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1720 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1721 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1722 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1723
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001724stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001725 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some stats
1726 instances on certain processes only. The default and only accepted value is
1727 "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this setting.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001728
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001729server-state-base <directory>
1730 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001731 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1732 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001733
1734server-state-file <file>
1735 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1736 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1737 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1738 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1739 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1740 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1741 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1742 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001743 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1744 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001745
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001746set-var <var-name> <expr>
1747 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1748 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1749 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1750 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1751 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1752 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1753 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1754 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1755 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1756
1757 Example:
1758 global
1759 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1760 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1761 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1762
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001763setenv <name> <value>
1764 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1765 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1766 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1767 and "unsetenv".
1768
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001769set-dumpable
1770 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001771 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1772 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1773 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1774 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1775 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1776 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1777 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1778 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1779 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1780 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1781 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1782 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1783 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1784 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1785 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001786 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001787 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001788
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001789ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1790 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1791 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001792 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001793 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001794 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1795 information and recommendations see e.g.
1796 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1797 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1798 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1799 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001800
1801ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1802 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1803 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1804 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1805 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1806 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001807 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1808 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1809 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001810 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001811
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001812ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1813 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1814 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1815 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1816 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1817 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1818
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001819ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1820 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1821 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1822 keyword to see available options.
1823
1824 Example:
1825 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001826 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001827
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001828ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1829 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1830 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001831 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001832 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001833 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1834 information and recommendations see e.g.
1835 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1836 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1837 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1838 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1839 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001840
1841ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1842 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1843 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1844 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1845 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1846 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001847 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1848 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1849 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1850 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001851
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001852ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1853 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1854 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1855 keyword to see available options.
1856
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001857ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1858 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1859 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1860 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001861 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001862 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001863 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1864 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1865 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1866 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001867 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1868 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1869 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1870
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001871ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1872 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1873 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001874 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001875 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001876 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1877
1878 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001879
1880 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1881 and won't try to remove them.
1882
1883 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1884
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001885ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001886 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001887 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1888 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1889 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001890
1891 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1892 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1893 optimize the startup time.
1894
1895 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1896 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1897 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1898
1899 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001900 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001901
1902 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001903 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1904 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001905
1906 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1907 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1908 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1909 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1910 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001911 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001912
1913 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001914 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001915 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1916 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1917 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1918 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1919 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001920 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001921
1922 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1923
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001924 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001925 a cert bundle.
1926
1927 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1928 separately in several "crt".
1929
1930 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1931 since files are loading separately.
1932
1933 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1934 required to commit them.
1935
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001936 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001937 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001938
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001939 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1940 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1941 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001942
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001943 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1944 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1945 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001946
1947 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001948 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
1949 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001950
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001951 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1952 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1953
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001954 The default behavior is "all".
1955
1956 Example:
1957 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1958 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1959 ssl-load-extra-files none
1960
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001961 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
1962 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001963
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001964ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1965 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1966 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1967 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1968
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001969ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001970 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001971 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1972 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1973 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1974 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1975 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1976 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001977 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001978
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001979stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1980 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1981 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1982 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001983 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001984 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001985
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001986 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1987 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1988 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001989
1990stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1991 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1992 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001993 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001994
1995stats maxconn <connections>
1996 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1997 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1998
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001999uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002000 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002001 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2002 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2003 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2004
2005ulimit-n <number>
2006 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2007 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2008 option.
2009
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002010 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2011 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2012 manually specify this value.
2013
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002014unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2015 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2016
2017 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2018 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2019 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2020 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2021 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002022 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002023 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2024 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2025 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2026 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2027
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002028unsetenv [<name> ...]
2029 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2030 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2031 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2032 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2033 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2034 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2035 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2036
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002037user <user name>
2038 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2039 See also "uid" and "group".
2040
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002041node <name>
2042 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2043
2044 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2045 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2046 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2047 traffic.
2048
2049description <text>
2050 Add a text that describes the instance.
2051
2052 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2053 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2054 "<" and ">" characters.
2055
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100205651degrees-data-file <file path>
2057 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002058 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002059
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002060 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002061 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2062
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000206351degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002064 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2065 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2066 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2067
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002068 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002069 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2070
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200207151degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002072 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2073 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2074
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002075 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002076 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2077
207851degrees-cache-size <number>
2079 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2080 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2081 By default, this cache is disabled.
2082
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002083 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002084 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2085
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002086wurfl-data-file <file path>
2087 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2088 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2089
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002090 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002091 with USE_WURFL=1.
2092
2093wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2094 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2095 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2096 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2097
2098 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2099
2100 Valid WURFL properties are:
2101 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2102
2103 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2104 device.
2105
2106 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2107 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2108
2109 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2110 particular web request.
2111
2112 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2113 used Libwurfl API version.
2114
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002115 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2116 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2117
2118 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2119 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2120
2121 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2122
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002123 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002124 with USE_WURFL=1.
2125
2126wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2127 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2128 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2129
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002130 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002131 with USE_WURFL=1.
2132
2133wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2134 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2135 thus before the chroot.
2136
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002137 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002138 with USE_WURFL=1.
2139
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002140wurfl-cache-size <size>
2141 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2142 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002143 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002144 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002145
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002146 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002147 with USE_WURFL=1.
2148
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002149strict-limits
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002150 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002151 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2152 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002153 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002154 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002155
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021563.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002157-----------------------
2158
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002159busy-polling
2160 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2161 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2162 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2163 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2164 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2165 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2166 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2167 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2168 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2169 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2170 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2171 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2172 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2173 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2174 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2175 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2176 "poll" pollers.
2177
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002178 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2179 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2180 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2181
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002182max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002183 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002184 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2185 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2186 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2187 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2188 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2189 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2190 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2191
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002192maxconn <number>
2193 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2194 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2195 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002196 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2197 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2198 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2199 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002200 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2201 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2202 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2203 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2204 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2205 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002206
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002207maxconnrate <number>
2208 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2209 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2210 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2211 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2212 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2213 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2214 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2215 fairness.
2216
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002217maxcomprate <number>
2218 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002219 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002220 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2221 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2222 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002223 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002224 default value.
2225
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002226maxcompcpuusage <number>
2227 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2228 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2229 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002230 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2231 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2232 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2233 and from introducing high latencies.
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002234
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002235maxpipes <number>
2236 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2237 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2238 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2239 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2240 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2241 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2242
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002243maxsessrate <number>
2244 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2245 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2246 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2247 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2248 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2249 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2250 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2251 fairness.
2252
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002253maxsslconn <number>
2254 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2255 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2256 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2257 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2258 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2259 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2260 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002261 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2262 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2263 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2264 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002265 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002266 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2267 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002268
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002269maxsslrate <number>
2270 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2271 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2272 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2273 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2274 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2275 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2276 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2277 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2278 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2279 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2280
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002281maxzlibmem <number>
2282 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2283 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2284 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002285 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2286 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2287 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2288
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002289noepoll
2290 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2291 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002292 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002293
2294nokqueue
2295 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2296 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2297 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2298
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002299noevports
2300 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2301 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2302 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2303 also "nopoll".
2304
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002305nopoll
2306 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2307 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002308 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002309 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2310 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002311
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002312nosplice
2313 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002314 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002315 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002316 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002317 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2318 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2319 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2320 "option splice-response".
2321
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002322nogetaddrinfo
2323 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2324 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2325
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002326noreuseport
2327 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2328 command line argument "-dR".
2329
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002330profiling.memory { on | off }
2331 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2332 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2333 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2334 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2335 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2336 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2337 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2338 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2339 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2340
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002341profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2342 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2343 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2344 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2345 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002346 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002347 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2348 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2349 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2350 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2351
2352 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2353 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2354 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2355 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2356 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002357 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2358 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2359 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2360 CLI.
2361
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002362spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002363 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2364 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2365 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2366 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2367 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2368 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002369
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002370ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002371 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002372 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002373 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002374 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002375 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2376 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2377 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002378 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2379 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002380 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2381 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2382 openssl configuration file uses:
2383 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2384
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002385ssl-mode-async
2386 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002387 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002388 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2389 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002390 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002391 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002392 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002393
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002394tune.buffers.limit <number>
2395 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2396 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2397 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2398 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2399 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002400 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002401 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2402 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2403 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2404 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2405 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2406 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2407 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2408 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002409 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002410
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002411tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2412 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2413 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2414 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002415 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002416
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002417tune.bufsize <number>
2418 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2419 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2420 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2421 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2422 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2423 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2424 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002425 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2426 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002427 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002428 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002429 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002430 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2431 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002432
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002433tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2434 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2435 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2436 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2437 this value. The default value is 1.
2438
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002439tune.fail-alloc
2440 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2441 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2442 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2443 gracefully.
2444
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002445tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2446 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2447 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2448 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2449 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2450 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2451
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002452tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2453 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2454 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2455 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2456 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2457 change it.
2458
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002459tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2460 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002461 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002462 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002463 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2464 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2465 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2466 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2467 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2468
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002469tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2470 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2471 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2472 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2473 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2474 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002475 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002476 recommended not to change this value.
2477
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002478tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002479 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002480 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002481 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002482 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2483 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2484 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2485 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2486
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002487tune.http.cookielen <number>
2488 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2489 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2490 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2491 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2492 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2493 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2494 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2495 to change this value.
2496
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002497tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002498 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2499 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002500 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002501 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002502 configuration directives too.
2503 The default value is 1024.
2504
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002505tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2506 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2507 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2508 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2509 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2510 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2511 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002512 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2513 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2514 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002515
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002516tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2517 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2518 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2519 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2520 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2521 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2522 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002523 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2524 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2525 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2526 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2527 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002528
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002529tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002530 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002531 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2532 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2533 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2534 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002535 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002536 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002537 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002538 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2539
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002540tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2541 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2542 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2543 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2544 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2545 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2546 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2547 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2548 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2549 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2550
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002551tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2552 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002553 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002554 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2555 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002556 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002557 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2558 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2559
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002560tune.lua.maxmem
2561 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2562 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2563 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2564 memory.
2565
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002566tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2567 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002568 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2569 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002570 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002571
2572tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2573 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2574 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2575 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2576 check servers.
2577
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002578tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2579 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2580 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2581 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002582 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002583
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002584tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002585 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2586 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002587 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2588 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2589 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2590 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2591 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2592 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2593 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2594 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2595 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002596
2597tune.maxpollevents <number>
2598 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2599 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2600 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2601 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2602 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2603
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002604tune.maxrewrite <number>
2605 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2606 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2607 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2608 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2609 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2610 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2611 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2612 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2613 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2614 bufsize.
2615
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002616tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2617 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2618 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2619 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2620 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2621 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2622 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2623 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2624 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2625 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002626 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2627 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002628 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2629 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2630 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2631 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2632 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2633 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2634 setting this parameter to 0.
2635
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002636tune.pipesize <number>
2637 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2638 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2639 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2640 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2641 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2642 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2643
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002644tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2645 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002646 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002647 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2648 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2649 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2650 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002651 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002652
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002653tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2654 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002655 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002656 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2657 default is 20.
2658
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002659tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2660tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2661 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2662 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2663 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002664 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002665 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002666 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2667 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2668
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002669tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002670 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002671 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2672 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2673 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2674 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2675
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002676tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002677 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002678 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2679 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2680 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2681 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2682 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2683 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2684 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002685
2686tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2687 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002688 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002689 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2690 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2691 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2692 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2693 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2694 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2695 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002696
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002697tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2698tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2699 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2700 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2701 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002702 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002703 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002704 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2705 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2706 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2707 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002708 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002709
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002710tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002711 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002712 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2713 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2714 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2715 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2716 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2717 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2718 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2719 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2720 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002721 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
2722 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002723
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002724tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002725 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002726 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2727 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2728 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2729 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2730 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2731
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002732tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2733 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2734 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2735 performances. This is disabled by default.
2736
2737 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2738 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2739
2740 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2741
2742 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2743
2744 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2745
2746 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2747 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2748 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2749
2750 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2751 converted.
2752
2753 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2754 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2755 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2756 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2757 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2758 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2759 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002760 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2761 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002762
2763 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2764
2765 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2766 only need this line:
2767
2768 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2769
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002770tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2771 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002772 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002773 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2774 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2775 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2776 being used for too long.
2777
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002778tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2779 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2780 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2781 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2782 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2783 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2784 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2785 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2786 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2787 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2788 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002789 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002790 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002791
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002792tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2793 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2794 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2795 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2796 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002797 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002798 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2799 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002800 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2801 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002802
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002803tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2804 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2805 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2806 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2807 1000 entries.
2808
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02002809tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size <number>
2810tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number> (deprecated)
Marcin Deranek769fd2e2021-07-12 14:16:55 +02002811 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
2812 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
2813 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
2814 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002815
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002816tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002817tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002818tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2819tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2820tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002821 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2822 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2823 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2824 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2825 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2826 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2827 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2828 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002829
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002830 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2831 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2832 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2833 all available space is consumed.
2834 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2835 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2836 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002837
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002838tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2839 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002840 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002841 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002842 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002843 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2844
2845tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2846 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2847 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002848 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2849 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002850
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028513.3. Debugging
2852--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002853
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002854quiet
2855 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2856 line argument "-q".
2857
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002858zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002859 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002860 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2861 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2862 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2863 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2864 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2865
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002866
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010028673.4. Userlists
2868--------------
2869It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2870http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2871it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2872
2873userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002874 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002875 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2876
2877group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002878 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002879 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2880 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2881
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002882user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2883 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002884 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2885 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002886 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2887 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2888 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2889 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002890
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002891 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2892 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2893 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2894 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2895 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2896 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2897 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002898 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002899 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002900
2901 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002902 userlist L1
2903 group G1 users tiger,scott
2904 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002905
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002906 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2907 user scott insecure-password elgato
2908 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002909
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002910 userlist L2
2911 group G1
2912 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002913
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002914 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2915 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2916 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002917
2918 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002919
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002920
29213.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002922----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002923It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002924several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002925instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2926values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2927automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2928In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2929using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2930tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2931reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2932Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2933that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2934each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002935
2936peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002937 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002938 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2939
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002940bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2941 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2942 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2943
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002944disabled
2945 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2946 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2947 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2948
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002949default-bind [param*]
2950 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2951
2952default-server [param*]
2953 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2954
2955 Arguments:
2956 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2957 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2958 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2959 details.
2960
2961
2962 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2963
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002964enable
2965 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2966
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002967log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002968 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2969 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2970 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2971 more details.
2972
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002973peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002974 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2975 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002976 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002977 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002978 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2979 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2980 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002981
2982 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2983 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2984
2985 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002986 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2987 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2988 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002989
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002990 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2991 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002992
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002993 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2994 "server" keyword explanation below).
2995
2996server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002997 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002998 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2999 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
3000 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
3001 of this "peers" section).
3002 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
3003
3004
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003005 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003006 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003007 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003008 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3009 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3010 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003011
3012 backend mybackend
3013 mode tcp
3014 balance roundrobin
3015 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3016 stick on src
3017
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003018 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3019 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003020
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003021 Example:
3022 peers mypeers
3023 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3024 default-server ssl verify none
3025 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
3026 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003027
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003028
3029table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3030 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3031
3032 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3033 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003034 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003035 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3036 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3037 "stick-table" keyword).
3038
3039 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3040 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3041 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3042 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3043 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3044 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3045 of the stick-table name as follows:
3046
3047 peers mypeers
3048 peer A ...
3049 peer B ...
3050 table t1 ...
3051
3052 frontend fe1
3053 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3054
3055 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3056 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3057
3058 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3059 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3060 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3061 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3062 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3063 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3064 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3065
3066 peers mypeers
3067 peer A ...
3068 peer B ...
3069 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3070
3071 backend t1
3072 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3073
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003074 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003075 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3076 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3077
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090030783.6. Mailers
3079------------
3080It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3081If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3082in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3083
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003084mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003085 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3086 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3087
3088mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3089 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3090
3091 Example:
3092 mailers mymailers
3093 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3094 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3095
3096 backend mybackend
3097 mode tcp
3098 balance roundrobin
3099
3100 email-alert mailers mymailers
3101 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3102 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3103
3104 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3105 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3106
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003107timeout mail <time>
3108 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3109 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3110 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3111 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3112
3113 Example:
3114 mailers mymailers
3115 timeout mail 20s
3116 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003117
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031183.7. Programs
3119-------------
3120In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3121master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3122managed the same way as the workers.
3123
3124During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3125sequence as a worker:
3126
3127 - the master is re-executed
3128 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3129 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3130 instance of the program
3131
3132During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3133
3134program <name>
3135 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3136 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3137 the management guide).
3138
3139command <command> [arguments*]
3140 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3141 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3142 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3143 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3144
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003145user <user name>
3146 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3147 See also "group".
3148
3149group <group name>
3150 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3151 See also "user".
3152
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003153option start-on-reload
3154no option start-on-reload
3155 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3156 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3157 program section.
3158
3159
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010031603.8. HTTP-errors
3161----------------
3162
3163It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3164imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3165several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3166
3167http-errors <name>
3168 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3169 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3170
3171errorfile <code> <file>
3172 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3173
3174 Arguments :
3175 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003176 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003177 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003178
3179 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3180 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3181 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3182 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3183 before any chroot is performed.
3184
3185 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3186
3187 Example:
3188 http-errors website-1
3189 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3190 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3191 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3192
3193 http-errors website-2
3194 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3195 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3196 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3197
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020031983.9. Rings
3199----------
3200
3201It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3202servers or traces.
3203
3204ring <ringname>
3205 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3206
3207description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003208 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003209 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3210
3211format <format>
3212 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3213
3214 Arguments:
3215 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3216 one of the following :
3217
3218 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3219 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3220 designed to be used with a local log server.
3221
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003222 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3223 field is stripped. This is the default.
3224 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3225 rfc3164.
3226
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003227 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3228 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3229 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3230 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3231 is the default.
3232
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003233 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003234 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3235
3236 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3237 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3238
3239 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3240 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3241 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3242 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3243 logger consumes.
3244
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003245 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3246 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3247 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3248 with a local log server.
3249
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003250 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3251 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3252 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3253 used with a local log server.
3254
3255maxlen <length>
3256 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3257 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3258 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3259
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003260server <name> <address> [param*]
3261 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3262 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3263 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3264 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3265 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3266 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3267 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3268 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3269 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003270 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3271 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003272
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003273size <size>
3274 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3275 set to BUFSIZE.
3276
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003277timeout connect <timeout>
3278 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3279
3280 Arguments :
3281 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3282 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3283 as explained at the top of this document.
3284
3285timeout server <timeout>
3286 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3287
3288 Arguments :
3289 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3290 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3291 as explained at the top of this document.
3292
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003293 Example:
3294 global
3295 log ring@myring local7
3296
3297 ring myring
3298 description "My local buffer"
3299 format rfc3164
3300 maxlen 1200
3301 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003302 timeout connect 5s
3303 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003304 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003305
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020033063.10. Log forwarding
3307-------------------
3308
3309It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003310HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003311
3312log-forward <name>
3313 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3314
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003315backlog <conns>
3316 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3317 on connections accept.
3318
3319bind <addr> [param*]
3320 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003321 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3322 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3323 syslog protocol over TCP.
3324 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003325 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3326
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003327dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003328 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3329 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3330 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3331 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003332 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003333
3334log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003335log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003336 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3337 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3338 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003339 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003340 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3341 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3342 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003343 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003344
3345 Example:
3346 global
3347 log stderr format iso local7
3348
3349 ring myring
3350 description "My local buffer"
3351 format rfc5424
3352 maxlen 1200
3353 size 32764
3354 timeout connect 5s
3355 timeout server 10s
3356 # syslog tcp server
3357 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3358
3359 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003360 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3361 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003362 # all messages on stderr
3363 log global
3364 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3365 log ring@myring local0
3366 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3367 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3368 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3369 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3370 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003371
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003372maxconn <conns>
3373 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3374 10 is the default.
3375
3376timeout client <timeout>
3377 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3378
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033794. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003380----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003381
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003382Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003383 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3384 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3385 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3386 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003387
3388A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3389connections.
3390
3391A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3392to forward incoming connections.
3393
3394A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3395parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3396
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003397A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3398ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3399sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3400the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3401explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3402from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3403"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3404for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3405to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3406optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3407are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3408any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3409names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3410that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3411duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3412names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3413
3414Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3415settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3416of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3417profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3418timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3419
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003420All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3421'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3422case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3423
3424Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3425logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3426proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3427However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3428name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3429
3430Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3431and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003432bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003433protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3434modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3435arbitrary criteria.
3436
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003437In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3438a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003439the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003440
3441 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3442 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3443 between responses and new requests.
3444
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003445 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3446 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3447 client-facing connection remains open.
3448
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003449 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3450 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003451
3452The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3453frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3454following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003455weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003456
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003457 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003458
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003459 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3460 ----+-----+-----+----
3461 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3462 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003463 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3464 ----+-----+-----+----
3465 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003466
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003467It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003468only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3469within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003470as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003471content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003472and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3473possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003474
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003475There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003476first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003477processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003478second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003479protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3480is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3481new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003482to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003483process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3484already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3485HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3486evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3487one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3488
3489There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3490performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3491tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3492preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3493analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3494HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3495header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3496mitigate this drawback.
3497
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003498There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003499method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3500set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3501in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3502is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3503to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3504above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3505to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3506"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3507frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3508frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3509as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3510upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3511on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3512the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3513upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3514frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3515remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003516
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035174.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3518--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003519
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003520The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3521limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3522they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3523limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003524marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003525option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003526and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3527with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3528specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003529
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003530
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003531 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3532------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3533acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003534backlog X X X -
3535balance X - X X
3536bind - X X -
3537bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003538capture cookie - X X -
3539capture request header - X X -
3540capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003541clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3542clitcpka-idle X X X -
3543clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003544compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003545cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003546declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003547default-server X - X X
3548default_backend X X X -
3549description - X X X
3550disabled X X X X
3551dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003552email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003553email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003554email-alert mailers X X X X
3555email-alert myhostname X X X X
3556email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003557enabled X X X X
3558errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003559errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003560errorloc X X X X
3561errorloc302 X X X X
3562-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3563errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003564force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003565filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003566fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003567hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003568http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003569http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003570http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003571http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003572http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003573http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003574http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003575http-check set-var X - X X
3576http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003577http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003578http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003579http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003580http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003581http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003582id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003583ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003584load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003585log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003586log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003587log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003588log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003589max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003590maxconn X X X -
3591mode X X X X
3592monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003593monitor-uri X X X -
3594option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3595option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3596option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3597option allbackups (*) X - X X
3598option checkcache (*) X - X X
3599option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3600option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003601option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003602option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3603option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003604-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3605option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003606option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3607option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003608option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003609option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003610option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003611option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003612option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003613option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3614option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3615option httpchk X - X X
3616option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003617option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02003618option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003619option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003620option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003621option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003622option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3623option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3624option logasap (*) X X X -
3625option mysql-check X - X X
3626option nolinger (*) X X X X
3627option originalto X X X X
3628option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003629option pgsql-check X - X X
3630option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003631option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003632option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003633option smtpchk X - X X
3634option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3635option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3636option splice-request (*) X X X X
3637option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003638option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003639option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3640option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3641-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003642option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003643option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3644option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3645option tcpka X X X X
3646option tcplog X X X X
3647option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003648external-check command X - X X
3649external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003650persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3651rate-limit sessions X X X -
3652redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003653-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003654retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003655retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003656server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003657server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003658server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003659source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003660srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3661srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3662srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003663stats admin - X X X
3664stats auth X X X X
3665stats enable X X X X
3666stats hide-version X X X X
3667stats http-request - X X X
3668stats realm X X X X
3669stats refresh X X X X
3670stats scope X X X X
3671stats show-desc X X X X
3672stats show-legends X X X X
3673stats show-node X X X X
3674stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003675-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3676stick match - - X X
3677stick on - - X X
3678stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003679stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003680stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003681tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003682tcp-check connect X - X X
3683tcp-check expect X - X X
3684tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003685tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003686tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003687tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003688tcp-check set-var X - X X
3689tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003690tcp-request connection - X X -
3691tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003692tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003693tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003694tcp-response content - - X X
3695tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003696timeout check X - X X
3697timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003698timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003699timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003700timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3701timeout http-request X X X X
3702timeout queue X - X X
3703timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003704timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003705timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003706timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003707transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003708unique-id-format X X X -
3709unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003710use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003711use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003712use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003713------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3714 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003715
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003716
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037174.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3718---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003719
3720This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3721
3722
3723acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3724 Declare or complete an access list.
3725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3726 no | yes | yes | yes
3727 Example:
3728 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3729 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3730 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3731
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003732 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003733
3734
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003735backlog <conns>
3736 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3738 yes | yes | yes | no
3739 Arguments :
3740 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3741 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003742 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003743
3744 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3745 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3746 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3747 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3748 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3749 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3750 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3751 backlog parameter.
3752
3753 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3754 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3755 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3756
3757 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3758
3759
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003760balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003761balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003762 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3764 yes | no | yes | yes
3765 Arguments :
3766 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3767 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3768 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3769 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3770
3771 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3772 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3773 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3774 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003775 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003776 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003777 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3778 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3779 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3780 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3781 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3782 it, so that you don't worry.
3783
3784 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3785 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3786 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3787 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3788 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3789 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3790 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3791 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003792
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003793 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3794 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3795 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3796 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3797 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3798 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3799 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003800 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3801 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3802 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003803
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003804 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003805 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003806 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3807 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003808 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003809 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3810 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3811 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3812 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3813 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003814 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3815 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3816 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3817 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3818 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3819 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003820
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003821 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3822 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3823 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3824 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3825 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3826 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3827 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3828 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003829 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003830 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003831 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3832 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3833 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003834
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003835 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3836 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3837 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3838 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3839 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3840 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3841 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3842 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3843 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3844 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3845 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3846 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003847
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003848 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003849 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3850 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3851 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3852 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3853 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3854 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3855 URIs start with a leading "/".
3856
3857 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3858 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3859 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3860 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3861
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003862 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3863 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3864 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3865 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3866
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003867 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003868 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3869
3870 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003871 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3872 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003873 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3874 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3875 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3876 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003877 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003878 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3879 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003880
3881 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3882 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3883 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3884 server will receive the request.
3885
3886 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3887 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3888 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3889 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3890 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003891 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3892 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3893 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003894
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003895 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3896 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3897 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3898 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3899 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003900
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003901 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003902 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3903 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3904 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3905
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003906 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3907 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3908 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3909
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003910 random
3911 random(<draws>)
3912 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003913 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3914 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3915 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3916 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003917 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3918 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3919 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3920 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3921 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3922 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3923 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3924 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3925 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3926 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3927 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3928 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3929 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3930 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3931 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3932 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3933 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3934 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3935 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3936 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003937
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003938 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003939 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003940 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3941 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3942 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3943 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3944 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3945 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003946 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003947 used instead.
3948
3949 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3950 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3951 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3952 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3953
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003954 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3955 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3956 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3957
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003958 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003959
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003960 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003961 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3962 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003963
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003964 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3965 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3966 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003967
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003968 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003969 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003970 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3971 NTLM relies on.
3972
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003973 Examples :
3974 balance roundrobin
3975 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003976 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003977 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3978 balance hdr(host)
3979 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003980
3981 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3982 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3983
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003984 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003985 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3986 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3987 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003988 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003989
3990 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3991 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3992 defaults to 16 kB.
3993
3994 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3995 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3996
3997 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3998 Round Robin.
3999
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004000 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004001 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4002 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4003 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4004
4005 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4006
4007 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004008 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004009 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4010 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4011 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004012
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02004013 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004014
4015
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004016bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4017bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004018 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4020 no | yes | yes | no
4021 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004022 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4023 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4024 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4025 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004026 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004027 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4028 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4029 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4030 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4031 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4032 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004033 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004034 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4035 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004036 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004037 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4038 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004039 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004040 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4041 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004042 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004043 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004044 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4045 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4046 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004047 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4048 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4049 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4050 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004051 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4052 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4053 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004054
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004055 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4056 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004057 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4058 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4059 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004060 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4061 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4062 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4063 the range.
4064
4065 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4066 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4067 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4068 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4069 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4070 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4071 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004072 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004073 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004074
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004075 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004076 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004077 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4078 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4079 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4080 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4081 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4082 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4083
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004084 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4085 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4086 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4087 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004088
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004089 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4090 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4091 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4092 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4093 in a frontend.
4094
4095 Example :
4096 listen http_proxy
4097 bind :80,:443
4098 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004099 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004100
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004101 listen http_https_proxy
4102 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004103 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004104
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004105 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4106 bind ipv6@:80
4107 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4108 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4109
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004110 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004111 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004112
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004113 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4114 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4115 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4116 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4117 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4118
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004119 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004120 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004121
4122
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004123bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4125 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004126
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02004127 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some
4128 frontends on certain processes only, or to adjust backends so that they
4129 could match the frontends that used them. The default and only accepted
4130 value is "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this
4131 setting. Threads can still be bound per-socket using the "process" bind
4132 keyword.
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004133
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02004134 See also : "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004135
4136
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004137capture cookie <name> len <length>
4138 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4140 no | yes | yes | no
4141 Arguments :
4142 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4143 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4144 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4145 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004146 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004147
4148 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4149 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4150 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4151 right if it exceeds <length>.
4152
4153 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4154 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4155 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4156 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4157
4158 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4159 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4160 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4161
4162 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4163 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4164 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004165 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4166 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4167 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004168
4169 Example:
4170 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4171
4172 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004173 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004174
4175
4176capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004177 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4179 no | yes | yes | no
4180 Arguments :
4181 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004182 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004183 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4184 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4185 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4186
4187 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4188 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4189 it exceeds <length>.
4190
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004191 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004192 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4193 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004194 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4195 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4196 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4197 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004198 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004199 environments to find where the request came from.
4200
4201 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4202 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4203 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4204 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004205
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004206 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4207 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4208 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4209 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4210 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004211
4212 Example:
4213 capture request header Host len 15
4214 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004215 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004216
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004217 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004218 about logging.
4219
4220
4221capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004222 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4224 no | yes | yes | no
4225 Arguments :
4226 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004227 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004228 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4229 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4230 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4231
4232 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4233 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4234 it exceeds <length>.
4235
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004236 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004237 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4238 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4239 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004240 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4241 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4242 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4243 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004244
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004245 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4246 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4247 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4248 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4249 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004250
4251 Example:
4252 capture response header Content-length len 9
4253 capture response header Location len 15
4254
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004255 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004256 about logging.
4257
4258
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004259clitcpka-cnt <count>
4260 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4261 the connection on the client side.
4262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4263 yes | yes | yes | no
4264 Arguments :
4265 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4266
4267 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4268 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004269 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4270 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004271
4272 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4273
4274
4275clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4276 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4277 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4278 client side.
4279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4280 yes | yes | yes | no
4281 Arguments :
4282 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4283 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4284 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4285 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4286
4287 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4288 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004289 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4290 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004291
4292 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4293
4294
4295clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4296 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4298 yes | yes | yes | no
4299 Arguments :
4300 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4301 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4302 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4303 document.
4304
4305 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4306 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004307 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4308 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004309
4310 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4311
4312
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004313compression algo <algorithm> ...
4314compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004315compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004316 Enable HTTP compression.
4317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4318 yes | yes | yes | yes
4319 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004320 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4321 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004322 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004323
4324 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004325 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4326 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4327 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004328
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004329 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004330 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004331
4332 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4333 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4334 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4335 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4336 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004337 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004338
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004339 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4340 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4341 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4342 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4343 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4344 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4345 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004346 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004347
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004348 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004349 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004350 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004351 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004352 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004353 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004354 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004355
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004356 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004357 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4358 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004359 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4360 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004361 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004362 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004363 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4364 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004365 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004366 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4367 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004368
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004369 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004370 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4371 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004372 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004373 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004374 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4375 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4376 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4377 "multipart"
4378 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4379 header
4380 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4381 and later
4382 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4383 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004384 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004385
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004386 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004387
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004388 Examples :
4389 compression algo gzip
4390 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004391
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004392
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004393cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004394 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4395 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004396 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004397 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4399 yes | no | yes | yes
4400 Arguments :
4401 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4402 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4403 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4404 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4405 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4406 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004407 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004408 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4409 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4410
4411 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004412 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004413 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4414 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4415 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4416 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004417 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4418 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004419 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004420 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4421 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004422
4423 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004424 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004425
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004426 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004427 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004428 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004429 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004430 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4431 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4432 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4433 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4434 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4435 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4436 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004437
4438 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4439 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4440 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4441 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4442 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4443 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4444 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4445 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4446 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004447 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004448 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4449 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4450 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004451
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004452 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4453 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4454 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004455 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4456 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4457 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4458 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004459 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4460 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4461 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004462
4463 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4464 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4465 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4466 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4467 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4468 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4469 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4470 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4471 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4472
4473 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4474 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4475 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4476 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4477 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4478 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4479 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4480 persistence cookie in the cache.
4481 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4482
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004483 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4484 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004485 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004486 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4487 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004488 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004489 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4490 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4491 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4492 they logout.
4493
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004494 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004495 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4496 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4497 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4498
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004499 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004500 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4501 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4502 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4503 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4504 this attribute.
4505
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004506 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004507 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004508 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4509 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4510 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4511 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4512 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4513 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004514
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004515 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4516 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4517 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4518 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4519 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4520 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4521 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4522 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004523 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004524 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4525 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4526 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4527 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4528 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4529 the site.
4530
4531 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4532 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4533 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4534 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4535 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4536 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4537 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4538 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4539 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4540 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4541 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4542 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4543 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004544 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004545 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4546 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4547
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004548 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4549 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4550 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4551 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4552 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4553 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4554
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004555 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004556 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4557 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4558 repeated.
4559
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004560 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4561 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4562 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4563 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004564
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004565 Examples :
4566 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4567 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4568 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004569 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004570
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004571 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004572
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004573
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004574declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4575 Declares a capture slot.
4576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4577 no | yes | yes | no
4578 Arguments:
4579 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4580
4581 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4582 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4583 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4584 for use in the response.
4585
4586 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004587 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004588 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4589
4590
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004591default-server [param*]
4592 Change default options for a server in a backend
4593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4594 yes | no | yes | yes
4595 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004596 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4597 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4598 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4599 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004600
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004601 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004602 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4603
4604 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004605
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004606
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004607default_backend <backend>
4608 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4610 yes | yes | yes | no
4611 Arguments :
4612 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4613
4614 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4615 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4616 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4617 will catch all undetermined requests.
4618
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004619 Example :
4620
4621 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4622 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4623 default_backend dynamic
4624
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004625 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004626
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004627
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004628description <string>
4629 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4631 no | yes | yes | yes
4632 Arguments : string
4633
4634 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4635 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4636 it describes.
4637 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4638
4639
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004640disabled
4641 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4643 yes | yes | yes | yes
4644 Arguments : none
4645
4646 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4647 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4648 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4649 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4650 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4651 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4652 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4653
4654 See also : "enabled"
4655
4656
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004657dispatch <address>:<port>
4658 Set a default server address
4659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4660 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004661 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004662
4663 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4664 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4665 during start-up.
4666
4667 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4668 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4669 possible with normal servers.
4670
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004671 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004672 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4673 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4674 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4675 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4676
4677 See also : "server"
4678
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004679
4680dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4681 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4683 yes | no | yes | yes
4684 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4685
4686 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004687 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004688 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4689 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004690 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004691 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004692
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004693enabled
4694 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4696 yes | yes | yes | yes
4697 Arguments : none
4698
4699 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4700 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4701
4702 See also : "disabled"
4703
4704
4705errorfile <code> <file>
4706 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4708 yes | yes | yes | yes
4709 Arguments :
4710 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004711 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004712 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004713
4714 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004715 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004716 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004717 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4718 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004719
4720 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4721 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4722 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4723
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004724 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4725
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004726 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4727 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4728 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4729 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4730 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4731 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4732 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4733 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4734 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004735
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004736 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4737 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4738 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004739 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004740 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4741
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004742 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004743
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004744 Example :
4745 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004746 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004747 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4748 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4749
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004750
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004751errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4752 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4753 section.
4754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4755 yes | yes | yes | yes
4756 Arguments :
4757 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4758
4759 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004760 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004761 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4762 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004763
4764 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4765 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4766 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4767 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4768 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004769 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004770 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4771
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004772 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4773 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004774
4775 Example :
4776 errorfiles generic
4777 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4778
4779
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004780errorloc <code> <url>
4781errorloc302 <code> <url>
4782 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4784 yes | yes | yes | yes
4785 Arguments :
4786 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004787 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004788 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004789
4790 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4791 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4792 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4793 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004794 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004795
4796 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4797 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4798 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4799
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004800 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4801
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004802 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4803 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4804 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4805 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004806 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004807 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4808 request.
4809
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004810 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004811
4812
4813errorloc303 <code> <url>
4814 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4816 yes | yes | yes | yes
4817 Arguments :
4818 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004819 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004820 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004821
4822 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4823 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4824 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4825 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004826 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004827
4828 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4829 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4830 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4831
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004832 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4833
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004834 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4835 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4836 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4837 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004838 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004839
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004840 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004841
4842
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004843email-alert from <emailaddr>
4844 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004845 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004846 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4847 yes | yes | yes | yes
4848
4849 Arguments :
4850
4851 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4852
4853 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4854 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4855
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004856 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004857 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4858 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004859
4860
4861email-alert level <level>
4862 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4863 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4864 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4865 yes | yes | yes | yes
4866
4867 Arguments :
4868
4869 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4870 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4871 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4872
4873 By default level is alert
4874
4875 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4876 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4877 for the proxy.
4878
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004879 Alerts are sent when :
4880
4881 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4882 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4883 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4884 is notice or lower
4885 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4886 and a health check status update occurs
4887
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004888 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4889 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004890 section 3.6 about mailers.
4891
4892
4893email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4894 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4895 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4896 yes | yes | yes | yes
4897
4898 Arguments :
4899
4900 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4901
4902 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4903 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4904
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004905 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4906 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004907
4908
4909email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4910 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4911 mailers.
4912 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4913 yes | yes | yes | yes
4914
4915 Arguments :
4916
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004917 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004918
4919 By default the systems hostname is used.
4920
4921 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4922 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4923 for the proxy.
4924
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004925 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4926 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004927
4928
4929email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004930 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004931 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4932 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4933 yes | yes | yes | yes
4934
4935 Arguments :
4936
4937 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4938
4939 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4940 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4941
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004942 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004943 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4944
4945
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004946force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4947 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4948 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004949 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004950
4951 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4952 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4953 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4954 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4955 marked down for maintenance operations.
4956
4957 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4958 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4959 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4960 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4961 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4962 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4963 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4964 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4965 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4966
4967 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4968 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4969 is used.
4970
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004971 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004972 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004973
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004974
4975filter <name> [param*]
4976 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4978 no | yes | yes | yes
4979 Arguments :
4980 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4981 referenced in section 9.
4982
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004983 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004984 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004985 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4986 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004987
4988 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4989 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4990
4991 Example:
4992 listen
4993 bind *:80
4994
4995 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4996 filter compression
4997 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4998
4999 compression algo gzip
5000 compression offload
5001
5002 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5003
5004 See also : section 9.
5005
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005006
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005007fullconn <conns>
5008 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5010 yes | no | yes | yes
5011 Arguments :
5012 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5013 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5014
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005015 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005016 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005017 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005018 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5019 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5020 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5021 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5022 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005023 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005024
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005025 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005026 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005027 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5028 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5029 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005030
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005031 Example :
5032 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5033 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5034 # connections.
5035 backend dynamic
5036 fullconn 10000
5037 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5038 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5039
5040 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5041
5042
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005043hash-balance-factor <factor>
5044 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5046 yes | no | no | yes
5047 Arguments :
5048 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5049 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005050 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005051
5052 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5053 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5054 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5055 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5056 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5057 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5058 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5059
5060 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5061 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5062 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5063 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5064 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5065
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005066 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5067 consistent hashing mechanism.
5068
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005069 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5070
5071
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005072hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005073 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5075 yes | no | yes | yes
5076 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005077 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5078 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005079
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005080 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5081 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5082 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5083 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5084 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5085 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5086 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5087 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5088 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5089 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005090
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005091 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5092 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5093 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5094 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5095 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5096 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5097 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5098 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5099 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5100 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5101 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5102 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5103 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005104 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5105 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005106
5107 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5108
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005109 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005110 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5111 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5112 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005113 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5114 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5115 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005116
5117 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5118 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005119 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5120 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5121 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5122 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5123
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005124 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005125 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5126 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5127 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5128 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5129 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5130 parameter.
5131
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005132 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5133 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5134 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5135 used on strings.
5136
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005137 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5138
5139 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5140 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5141 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5142 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5143 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5144 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5145 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5146 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5147 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5148 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5149 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5150 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005151
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005152 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5153 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5154 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005155
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005156 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005157
5158
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005159http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5160 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5161 ones).
5162
5163 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5164 no | yes | yes | yes
5165
5166 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5167 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5168 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5169 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5170 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5171 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5172
5173 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5174 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5175 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5176
5177 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5178 below.
5179
5180 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5181 instance.
5182
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005183 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5184 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5185 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5186
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005187 Example:
5188 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5189 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5190 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5191
5192http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5193
5194 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5195 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5196 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5197 example, or to pass some internal information.
5198 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5199 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5200 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5201
5202http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5203
5204 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5205 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5206
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005207http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005208
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005209 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5210 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5211 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5212 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5213 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005214
5215http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5216 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5217
5218 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5219
5220 Example:
5221 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5222
5223 # applied to:
5224 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5225
5226 # outputs:
5227 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5228
5229 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5230
5231http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5232 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5233
5234 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5235
5236 Example:
5237 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5238
5239 # applied to:
5240 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5241
5242 # outputs:
5243 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5244
5245http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5246
5247 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5248 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5249 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5250
5251http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5252 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5253
5254 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5255 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5256 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5257 fallback.
5258
5259 Example:
5260 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5261 http-response set-status 431
5262 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5263 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5264
5265http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5266
5267 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5268 inline.
5269
5270 Arguments:
5271 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5272 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5273 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5274 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5275 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5276 (request and response)
5277 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5278 processing
5279 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5280 processing
5281 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5282 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5283 and '_'.
5284
5285 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5286 followed by some converters.
5287
5288 Example:
5289 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5290
5291http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5292
5293 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5294 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5295 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5296 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5297 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005298 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005299 processing.
5300
5301 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5302 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005303 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005304 rules evaluation.
5305
5306http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5307
5308 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5309 details about <var-name>.
5310
5311 Example:
5312 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5313
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005314
5315http-check comment <string>
5316 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5317 it fails.
5318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5319 yes | no | yes | yes
5320
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005321 Arguments :
5322 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5323 rule fails.
5324
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005325 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5326 user-friendly error reporting.
5327
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005328 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005329 "http-check expect".
5330
5331
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005332http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5333 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005334 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005335 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5337 yes | no | yes | yes
5338
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005339 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005340 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5341
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005342 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005343 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005344
5345 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5346 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5347 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5348 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5349
5350 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5351
5352 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5353
5354 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5355
5356 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5357
5358 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5359
5360 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5361 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5362 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5363 is used.
5364
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005365 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5366 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5367 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5368 haproxy -vv.
5369
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005370 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5371
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005372 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5373 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5374 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5375 different ports or with different servers.
5376
5377 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5378 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5379 the port with a "http-check connect".
5380
5381 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5382 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5383 do.
5384
5385 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5386 unset-var or comment rules.
5387
5388 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005389 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5390 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5391 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5392 option httpchk
5393
5394 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005395 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005396 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005397 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005398 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005399 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005400
5401 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5402
5403 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005404
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005405
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005406http-check disable-on-404
5407 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005409 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005410 Arguments : none
5411
5412 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5413 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5414 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5415 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5416 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5417 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5418 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5419 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005420 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5421 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005422 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5423 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5424 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005425
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005426 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005427
5428
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005429http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005430 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5431 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5432 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005433 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005435 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005436
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005437 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005438 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5439
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005440 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5441 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5442 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5443 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5444 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5445 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5446 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5447 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5448 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5449 result is always conclusive.
5450
5451 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5452 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5453 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005454 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5455 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005456 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5457 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005458 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5459 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5460 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005461
5462 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5463 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005464 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5465 supported :
5466 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5467 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005468 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5469 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5470 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5471 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5472 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005473
5474 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5475 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005476 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5477 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5478 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5479 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005480 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5481
5482 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5483 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5484 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5485 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5486
5487 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5488 informational message reported in logs if an error
5489 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5490 log-format string.
5491
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005492 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005493 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5494 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005495 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5496 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5497 details on the supported keywords.
5498
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005499 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5500 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5501 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5502 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005503
5504 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5505 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5506 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5507 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5508 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5509
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005510 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5511 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5512 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5513 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5514 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5515 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5516 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005517
5518 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005519 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005520 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5521 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5522 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5523 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5524
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005525 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5526 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005527 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5528 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5529 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5530 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5531 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5532 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5533 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5534 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005535 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5536 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5537 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5538 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5539 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5540 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5541 insensitive on the header names.
5542
5543 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5544 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5545 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5546 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5547 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5548 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005549
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005550 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005551 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005552 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5553 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5554 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5555 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5556 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005557 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005558 trace).
5559
5560 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005561 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005562 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5563 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5564 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5565 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5566 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005567 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005568
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005569 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5570 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5571 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5572 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5573 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5574 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5575
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005576 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005577 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005578 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5579 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5580 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5581 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5582 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5583 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5584
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005585 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5586 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5587 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5588 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5589 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005590
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005591 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5592 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5593
5594 Examples :
5595 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005596 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005597
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005598 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5599 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5600
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005601 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005602 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005603
5604 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005605 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005606
5607 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005608 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005609
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005610 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005611 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005612
5613
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005614http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005615 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5616 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005617 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5618 health checks.
5619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5620 yes | no | yes | yes
5621 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005622 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5623
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005624 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5625 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5626 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5627 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5628 to invent non-standard ones.
5629
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005630 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5631 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5632 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5633 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5634
5635 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5636 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5637 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5638 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005639
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005640 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005641 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005642 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005643 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5644 to add it.
5645
5646 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5647 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5648 to the log-format rules.
5649
5650 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5651 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5652 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005653
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005654 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5655 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5656 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5657 request.
5658
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005659 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5660 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5661 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005662 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5663 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5664 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5665 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005666 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005667
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005668 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005669 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5670 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005671
5672 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5673 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5674 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5675 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5676 configured request authority.
5677
5678 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5679 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005680
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005681 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005682
5683
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005684http-check send-state
5685 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5687 yes | no | yes | yes
5688 Arguments : none
5689
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005690 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005691 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005692 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5693 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5694 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005695
5696 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5697 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5698 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5699 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5700 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005701 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5702 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5703 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5704
5705 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5706 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5707 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5708
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005709 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5710 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5711 checked in multiple backends.
5712
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005713 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005714 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5715
5716 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5717 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5718 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5719 one fails.
5720
5721 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5722 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5723 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5724
5725 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5726 server's queue.
5727
5728 Example of a header received by the application server :
5729 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5730 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5731
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005732 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5733 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005734
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005735
5736http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005737 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005738 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5739 yes | no | yes | yes
5740
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005741 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005742 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5743 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5744 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5745 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5746 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5747 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5748 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5749 and '-'.
5750
5751 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5752
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005753 Examples :
5754 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005755
5756
5757http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005758 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005759 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5760 yes | no | yes | yes
5761
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005762 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005763 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5764 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5765 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5766 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5767 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5768 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5769 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5770 and '-'.
5771
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005772 Examples :
5773 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005774
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005775
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005776http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5777 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5778 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5779 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5780 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5782 yes | yes | yes | yes
5783 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005784 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005785 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005786 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005787 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005788
5789 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5790 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5791 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5792 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5793
5794 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5795 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5796 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5797 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5798
5799 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5800 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5801 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5802 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5803 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5804 chroot is performed.
5805
5806 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5807 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5808 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5809 considered.
5810
5811 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5812 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5813 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5814 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5815 considered as a raw string.
5816
5817 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5818 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5819 "content-type".
5820
5821 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5822 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5823 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5824 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5825 evaluated as a log-format string.
5826
5827 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5828 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5829 argument to "content-type".
5830
5831 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5832 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5833 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5834 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5835
5836 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5837 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5838 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5839 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5840 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5841 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5842 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5843 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5844
5845 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5846 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5847 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5848
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005849 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5850 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5851 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5852 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5853 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5854
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005855 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5856 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5857
5858
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005859http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005860 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5861
5862 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5863 no | yes | yes | yes
5864
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005865 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5866 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5867 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5868 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5869 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005870
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005871 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5872 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005873
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005874 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005875
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005876 Example:
5877 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5878 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5879 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005880
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005881 http-request allow if nagios
5882 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5883 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5884 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005885
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005886 Example:
5887 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5888 acl add path /addacl
5889 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005890
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005891 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005892
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005893 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5894 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005895
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005896 Example:
5897 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5898 acl setmap path /setmap
5899 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005900
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005901 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005902
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005903 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5904 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005905
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005906 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5907 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005908
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005909http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005910
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005911 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5912 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5913 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5914 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5915 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5916 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5917 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5918 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005919
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005920http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005921
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005922 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5923 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5924 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5925 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5926 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5927 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5928 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5929 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005930
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005931http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005932
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005933 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5934 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005935
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005936
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005937http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005938
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005939 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5940 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5941 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5942 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5943 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005944
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005945 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5946 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5947 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5948 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5949 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5950 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5951 instead.
5952
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005953 Example:
5954 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5955 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005956
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005957http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005958
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005959 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005960
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005961http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5962 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005963
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005964 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5965 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5966 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5967 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5968 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5969 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5970 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5971 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5972 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005973
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005974 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5975 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5976 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005977 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5978
5979 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5980 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5981 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5982 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005983
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005984http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005985
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005986 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5987 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5988 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5989 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5990 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5991 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005992
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005993http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005994
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005995 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5996 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5997 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5998 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5999 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006000
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006001http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006002
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006003 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6004 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6005 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6006 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6007 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6008 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006009
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006010http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6011http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6012 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6013 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6014 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6015 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006016
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006017 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6018 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6019 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006020 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006021 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6022 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6023 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006024 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006025 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006026
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006027http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6028 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6029 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6030 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6031
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006032http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6033
6034 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6035 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6036 pointed by <resolvers>.
6037 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6038 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6039 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6040 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6041 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6042 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6043 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6044 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6045 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6046 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6047 to 0.0.0.0.
6048
6049 Example:
6050 resolvers mydns
6051 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6052 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6053 timeout retry 1s
6054 hold valid 10s
6055 hold nx 3s
6056 hold other 3s
6057 hold obsolete 0s
6058 accepted_payload_size 8192
6059
6060 frontend fe
6061 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6062 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6063 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6064
6065 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6066 # which mean DNS resolution error
6067 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6068
6069 default_backend be
6070
6071 backend b_503
6072 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6073 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6074 # 503 error page to end users
6075
6076 backend be
6077 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6078 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6079 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6080 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6081 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6082
6083 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6084 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6085
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006086http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6087
6088 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6089 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6090 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6091 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006092 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6093 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006094
6095 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6096
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006097http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006098http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006099http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006100http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006101http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006102http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006103http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006104http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6105http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006106
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006107 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6108
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006109 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006110 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6111 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6112 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6113 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006114
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006115 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6116 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6117 the supported backend.
6118
6119 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6120 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6121 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6122 number of segments in the path.
6123
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006124 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6125 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6126 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6127 when improperly combined.
6128
6129 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6130 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6131 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6132 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6133 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6134
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006135 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006136
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006137 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6138
6139 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6140 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6141
6142 Example:
6143 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6144
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006145 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6146
6147 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6148 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6149
6150 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6151 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6152
6153 Example:
6154 - /#foo -> /
6155
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006156 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6157 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006158
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006159 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6160 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6161
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006162 Example:
6163 - /. -> /
6164 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6165 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6166 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006167
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006168 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6169 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6170
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006171 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006172 their preceding segment.
6173
6174 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6175 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6176
6177 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6178 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006179
6180 Example:
6181 - /foo/../ -> /
6182 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6183 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6184 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006185 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006186 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006187 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006188
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006189 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6190 removed as well:
6191
6192 Example:
6193 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6194 - /bar/../../ -> /
6195
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006196 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6197 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006198
6199 Example:
6200 - // -> /
6201 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6202
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006203 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6204 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6205
6206 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6207 ".", "_", and "~".
6208
6209 Example:
6210 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6211 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6212 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6213 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6214
6215 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6216 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6217
6218 Example:
6219 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6220 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6221
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006222 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006223 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006224
6225 Example:
6226 - /%6f -> /%6F
6227 - /%zz -> /%zz
6228
6229 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6230 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6231
6232 Example:
6233 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6234
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006235 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006236 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6237 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6238
6239 Example:
6240 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6241 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6242 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6243
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006244http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006245
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006246 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6247 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6248 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6249 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6250 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006251
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006252http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006253
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006254 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6255 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6256 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6257 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006258
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006259http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6260 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006261
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006262 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006263 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6264 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6265 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6266 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6267 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006268
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006269 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6270 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6271 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6272 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6273 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006274
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006275 Example:
6276 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6277
6278 # applied to:
6279 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6280
6281 # outputs:
6282 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6283
6284 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006285
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006286 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6287
6288 # applied to:
6289 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006290
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006291 # outputs:
6292 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006293
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006294http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6295 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6296
6297 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6298 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006299 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6300 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6301 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006302
6303 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6304 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6305 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6306
6307 Example:
6308 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6309 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6310
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006311 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6312 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6313 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6314 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6315
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006316http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6317 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6318
6319 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6320 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6321 query-string are replaced.
6322
6323 Example:
6324 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6325 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6326
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006327http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6328 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6329
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006330 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6331 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6332 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6333 against.
6334
6335 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6336 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6337 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006338
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006339 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6340 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6341 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6342 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6343 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6344 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6345 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6346 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6347 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006348 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6349 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006350
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006351 Example:
6352 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6353 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006354
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006355 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6356 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006357
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006358http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6359 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006360
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006361 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6362 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6363 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6364 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006365
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006366 Example:
6367 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006368
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006369 # applied to:
6370 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006371
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006372 # outputs:
6373 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006374
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006375http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6376 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6377 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006378 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006379 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6380
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006381 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006382 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6383 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006384 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006385 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006386 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006387 are followed to create the response :
6388
6389 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6390 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6391 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6392 ignored.
6393
6394 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6395 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006396 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006397 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6398 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006399
6400 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6401 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6402 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006403 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006404 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006405
6406 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6407 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6408 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006409 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006410 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006411 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006412
6413 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6414 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6415 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6416 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6417 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6418 as a raw content.
6419
6420 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6421 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6422 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6423 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6424 considered as a raw string.
6425
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006426 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006427 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6428 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6429 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6430
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006431 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6432 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006433 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006434
6435 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6436
6437 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006438 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006439 if { path /ping }
6440
6441 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6442 if { path /favicon.ico }
6443
6444 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6445 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6446 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6447
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02006448http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6449
6450 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
6451 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
6452 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6453 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6454 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
6455 at this index.
6456 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
6457 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
6458
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006459http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6460http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006461
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006462 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6463 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6464 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006465
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02006466http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6467 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6468 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
6469 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
6470 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
6471 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6472 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6473 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
6474 at this index.
6475 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
6476 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
6477
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006478http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6479 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006480
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006481 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6482 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6483 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6484 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006485
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006486http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006487
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006488 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6489 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6490 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6491 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6492 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006493
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006494 Arguments:
6495 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6496 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006497
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006498 Example:
6499 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6500 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006501
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006502 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6503 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006504
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006505http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006506
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006507 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6508 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6509 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006510
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006511 Arguments:
6512 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6513 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006514
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006515 Example:
6516 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6517 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006518
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006519 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6520 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6521 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006522
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006523http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006524
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006525 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6526 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6527 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6528 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6529 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006530
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006531 Example:
6532 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6533 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6534 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6535 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6536 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6537 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6538 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6539 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6540 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006541
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006542http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006543
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006544 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6545 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6546 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6547 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6548 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006549
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006550http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6551 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006552
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006553 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6554 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6555 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6556 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6557 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6558 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6559 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6560 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6561 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006562
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006563http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006564
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01006565 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
6566 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6567 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
6568 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
6569 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
6570 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
6571 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01006572 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
6573 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006574
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006575http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006576
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006577 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6578 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6579 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006580
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006581http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006582
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006583 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6584 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6585 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6586 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6587 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6588 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6589 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6590 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006591
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006592http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006593
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006594 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6595 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6596 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6597 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6598 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6599 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006600
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006601 Example :
6602 # prepend the host name before the path
6603 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006604
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006605http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6606
6607 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6608 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6609 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6610
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006611http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006612
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006613 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6614 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6615 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6616 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6617 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006618
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006619http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006620
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006621 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6622 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6623 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6624 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6625 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6626 values have higher priority.
6627 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6628 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6629 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6630 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6631 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006632
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006633http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006634
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006635 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6636 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6637 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6638 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6639 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6640 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6641 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006642
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006643 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006644
6645 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006646 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6647 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006648
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006649http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6650 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6651 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6652 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006653 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6654 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006655
6656 Arguments :
6657 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6658 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006659
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006660 See also "option forwardfor".
6661
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006662 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006663 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6664 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6665
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006666 # After the masking this will track connections
6667 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6668 http-request track-sc0 src
6669
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006670 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6671 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6672
6673http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6674
6675 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6676 expression.
6677
6678 Arguments:
6679 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6680 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006681
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006682 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006683 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6684 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6685
6686 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6687 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6688 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6689
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006690http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006691 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6692
6693 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6694 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6695 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6696 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6697 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6698
6699 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6700 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6701 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6702 results.
6703
6704 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006705 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6706 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006707
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006708http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6709
6710 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6711 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6712 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6713 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6714 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6715 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6716 information from the request.
6717
6718 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6719
6720http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6721
6722 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6723 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6724 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6725 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6726 path and the query string.
6727 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6728
6729http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6730
6731 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6732 inline.
6733
6734 Arguments:
6735 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6736 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6737 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6738 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6739 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6740 (request and response)
6741 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6742 processing
6743 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6744 processing
6745 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6746 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6747 and '_'.
6748
6749 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6750 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006751
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006752 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006753 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006754
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006755http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6756 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006757
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006758 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6759 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6760 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6761 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6762 agent name must be used.
6763
6764 Arguments:
6765 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6766
6767 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6768 configuration.
6769
6770http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6771
6772 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6773 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6774 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6775 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6776 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6777 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6778 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6779 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6780 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6781 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6782 action.
6783 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6784 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6785 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6786 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6787 you fully understand how it works.
6788
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006789http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6790
6791 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6792 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6793 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6794 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6795 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006796 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006797 processing.
6798
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006799 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006800 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6801 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6802 rules evaluation.
6803
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006804http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6805http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6806 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6807 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6808 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6809 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006810
6811 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6812 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6813 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006814 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6815 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6816 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6817 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6818 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6819 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006820 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006821 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6822 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6823 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006824 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006825 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6826 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6827 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6828 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6829 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006830
6831http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6832http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6833http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6834
6835 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6836 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6837 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6838 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006839 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006840 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6841 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6842 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6843 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6844 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6845 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6846 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6847
6848 Arguments :
6849 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6850 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6851 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6852 select which table entry to update the counters.
6853
6854 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6855 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6856 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6857 that table until the session ends.
6858
6859 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6860 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6861 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6862 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6863 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6864 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6865 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6866 useful information.
6867
6868 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6869 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6870 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6871 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6872 checks that make use of it.
6873
6874http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6875
6876 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006877
6878 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006879 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006880
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006881http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6882
6883 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6884 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6885 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6886 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6887 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6888 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6889
6890 Arguments :
6891 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6892
6893 Example:
6894 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6895
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006896http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6897 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6898
6899 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6900 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6901 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6902 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6903 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6904 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6905 http-buffer-request".
6906
6907 Arguments :
6908
6909 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
6910 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
6911
6912 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05006913 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006914 bytes.
6915
6916 Example:
6917 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
6918
6919 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6920
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006921http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006922
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006923 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6924 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6925 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006926
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006927
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006928http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006929 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6930
6931 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6932 no | yes | yes | yes
6933
6934 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6935 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6936 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6937 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6938 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6939 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6940
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006941 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6942 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006943
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006944 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006945
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006946 Example:
6947 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006948
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006949 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006950
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006951 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6952 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006953
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006954 Example:
6955 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006956
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006957 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006958
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006959 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6960 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006961
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006962 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6963 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006964
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006965http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006966
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006967 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6968 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6969 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6970 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6971 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6972 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6973 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6974 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006975
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006976http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006977
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006978 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6979 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6980 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6981 example, or to pass some internal information.
6982 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6983 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6984 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006985
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006986http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006987
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006988 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6989 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006990
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006991http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006992
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006993 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006994
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006995http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006996
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006997 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6998 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6999 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7000 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7001 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7002 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7003 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007004
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007005 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7006 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7007 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7008 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7009 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007010
7011 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7012 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7013 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7014 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007015
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007016http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007017
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007018 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7019 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7020 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7021 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7022 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7023 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007024
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007025http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007026
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007027 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7028 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7029 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7030 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7031 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007032
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007033http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007034
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007035 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7036 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7037 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7038 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7039 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7040 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007041
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007042http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7043http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7044 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7045 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7046 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7047 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007048
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007049 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7050 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7051 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007052 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007053 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7054 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7055 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007056 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007057 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007058
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007059http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007060
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007061 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7062 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7063 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7064 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7065 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7066 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007067
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007068http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7069 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007070
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007071 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7072 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007073
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007074 Example:
7075 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007076
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007077 # applied to:
7078 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007079
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007080 # outputs:
7081 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007082
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007083 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007084
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007085http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7086 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007087
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007088 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007089 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007090
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007091 Example:
7092 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007093
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007094 # applied to:
7095 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007096
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007097 # outputs:
7098 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007099
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007100http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7101 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7102 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007103 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007104 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7105
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007106 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007107 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7108 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007109 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007110 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007111 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007112 are followed to create the response :
7113
7114 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7115 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7116 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7117 ignored.
7118
7119 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7120 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007121 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007122 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7123 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007124
7125 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7126 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7127 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007128 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007129 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007130
7131 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7132 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7133 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007134 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007135 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007136 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007137
7138 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7139 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7140 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7141 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7142 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7143 as a raw content.
7144
7145 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7146 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7147 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7148 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7149 considered as a raw string.
7150
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007151 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7152 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7153 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7154 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7155
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007156 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7157 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007158 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007159
7160 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7161
7162 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007163 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007164 if { status eq 404 }
7165
7166 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7167 string "This is the end !" \
7168 if { status eq 500 }
7169
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007170http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7171
7172 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
7173 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
7174 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7175 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7176 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
7177 at this index.
7178 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7179 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7180
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007181http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7182http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007183
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007184 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7185 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7186 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007187
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007188http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7189 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7190
7191 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
7192 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
7193 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
7194 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7195 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7196 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
7197 at this index.
7198 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
7199 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
7200
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007201http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7202 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007203
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007204 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7205 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7206 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7207 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007208
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007209http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7210 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007211
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007212 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7213 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7214 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7215 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7216 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007217
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007218 Arguments:
7219 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007220
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007221 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7222 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007223
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007224http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007225
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007226 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7227 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7228 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007229
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007230http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7231
7232 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7233 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7234 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7235 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7236 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7237
7238http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7239
7240 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7241 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7242 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7243 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7244 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7245 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7246 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7247 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7248 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7249
7250http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7251
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01007252 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
7253 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7254 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
7255 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace.
7256 It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
7257 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
7258 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01007259 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
7260 and OpenBSD.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007261
7262http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7263
7264 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7265 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7266 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7267 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7268 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7269 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7270 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7271 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7272
7273http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7274 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7275
7276 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7277 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7278 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7279 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007280
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007281 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007282 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7283 http-response set-status 431
7284 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7285 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007286
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007287http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007288
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007289 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7290 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7291 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7292 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7293 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7294 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7295 based on some information from the request.
7296
7297 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7298
7299http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7300
7301 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7302 inline.
7303
7304 Arguments:
7305 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7306 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7307 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7308 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7309 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7310 (request and response)
7311 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7312 processing
7313 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7314 processing
7315 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7316 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7317 and '_'.
7318
7319 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7320 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007321
7322 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007323 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007324
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007325http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007326
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007327 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7328 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7329 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7330 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7331 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7332 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7333 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7334 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7335 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7336 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7337 action.
7338 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7339 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7340 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7341 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7342 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007343
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007344http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7345
7346 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7347 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7348 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7349 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7350 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007351 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007352 processing.
7353
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007354 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007355 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007356 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007357 rules evaluation.
7358
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007359http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7360http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7361http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007362
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007363 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7364 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7365 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7366 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7367 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007368 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007369
7370http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7371
7372 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7373 about <var-name>.
7374
7375 Example:
7376 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7377
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007378http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7379 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7380
7381 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7382 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7383 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7384 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7385 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7386 buffer is full.
7387
7388 Arguments :
7389
7390 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7391 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7392
7393 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007394 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007395 bytes.
7396
7397 Example:
7398 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007399
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007400http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7401 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7402
7403 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7404 yes | no | yes | yes
7405
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007406 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007407 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7408 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7409 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007410
7411 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7412
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007413 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7414 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7415 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7416 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7417 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7418 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7419 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007420 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007421 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7422 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007423
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007424 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7425 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7426 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7427 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7428 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7429 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7430 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007431 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7432 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7433 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7434 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7435 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7436 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007437
7438 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7439 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7440 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7441 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7442 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7443 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7444 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7445 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007446 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007447 downsides of rare connection failures.
7448
7449 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7450 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7451 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7452 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7453 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7454 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007455 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007456 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7457 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7458 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7459 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7460 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7461
7462 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007463 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7464 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7465 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7466 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007467
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007468 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7469 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007470
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007471 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007472
7473 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7474 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7475 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7476
7477 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7478
7479
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007480http-send-name-header [<header>]
7481 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007482 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7483 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007484 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007485 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7486
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007487 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7488 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7489 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7490 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7491 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7492 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7493 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7494 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7495 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7496 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7497 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7498 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7499 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7500 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7501 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7502 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007503
7504 See also : "server"
7505
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007506id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007507 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7509 no | yes | yes | yes
7510 Arguments : none
7511
7512 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7513 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7514 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007515
7516
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007517ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7518 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7519 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007520 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007521
7522 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7523 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7524 and running).
7525
7526 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7527 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7528 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007529 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007530 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7531
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007532 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7533 "unless" condition is met.
7534
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007535 Example:
7536 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7537 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7538 ignore-persist if url_static
7539
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007540 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7541
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007542load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7543 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7544 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7545 yes | no | yes | yes
7546
7547 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7548 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7549 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007550 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007551 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007552 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7553 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7554 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7555
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007556 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007557 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007558 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007559
7560 Arguments:
7561 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7562 named "server-state-file".
7563
7564 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7565 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7566 name is used as a file name.
7567
7568 none don't load any stat for this backend
7569
7570 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007571 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7572 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7573 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007574 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007575 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007576
7577 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7578 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7579
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007580 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007581
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007582 global
7583 stats socket /tmp/socket
7584 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007585
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007586 defaults
7587 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007588
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007589 backend bk
7590 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7591 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007592
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007593
7594 Then one can run :
7595
7596 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7597
7598 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7599
7600 1
7601 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7602 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7603 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7604
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007605 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007606
7607 global
7608 stats socket /tmp/socket
7609 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7610
7611 defaults
7612 load-server-state-from-file local
7613
7614 backend bk
7615 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7616 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7617
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007618
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007619 Then one can run :
7620
7621 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7622
7623 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7624
7625 1
7626 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7627 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7628 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7629
7630 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7631 "show servers state"
7632
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007633
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007634log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007635log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007636 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007637no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007638 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7640 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007641
7642 Prefix :
7643 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7644 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7645 prefix does not allow arguments.
7646
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007647 Arguments :
7648 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7649 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7650 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7651 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7652 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7653 parameter.
7654
7655 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7656 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7657
7658 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7659 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7660 standard syslog port).
7661
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007662 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7663 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7664 standard syslog port).
7665
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007666 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7667 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7668 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007669 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007670
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007671 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7672 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7673 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7674 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7675 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7676 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7677 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7678 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7679 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7680 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7681 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7682 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007683 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007684 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7685 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7686 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007687 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7688 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007689
7690 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7691 and "fd@2", see above.
7692
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007693 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7694 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7695 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7696 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7697 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7698 having the logs instantly available.
7699
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007700 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7701 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7702 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7703
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007704 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7705 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007706
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007707 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7708 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7709 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7710 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7711 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7712 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7713 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7714 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7715 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7716 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007717 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007718
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007719 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7720 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7721 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7722 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7723 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7724
7725 <sample_size>
7726 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7727 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7728 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7729 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7730 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7731
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007732 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7733 one of the following :
7734
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007735 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7736 field is stripped. This is the default.
7737 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7738 rfc3164.
7739
7740 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007741 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7742
7743 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7744 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7745
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007746 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7747 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7748 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7749 designed to be used with a local log server.
7750
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007751 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7752 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7753 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7754 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7755 systemd logger consumes.
7756
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007757 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7758 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7759 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7760 used with a local log server.
7761
7762 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7763 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7764 designed to be used with a local log server.
7765
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007766 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7767 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7768 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7769 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7770
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007771 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7772
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007773 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7774 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7775 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7776
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007777 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7778 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7779 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7780 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007781
7782 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7783 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7784 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007785 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7786 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7787 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7788 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7789 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007790
7791 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7792
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007793 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7794 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7795 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007796
7797 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7798 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7799 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7800 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7801
7802 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7803 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007804
7805 Example :
7806 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007807 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7808 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7809 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007810 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007811 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7812 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007813 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007814
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007815
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007816log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007817 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7818 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7819 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007820
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007821 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7822 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7823 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7824 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7825 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007826
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02007827 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
7828 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007829
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007830log-format-sd <string>
7831 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7832 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7833 yes | yes | yes | no
7834
7835 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7836 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7837 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7838 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7839 which covers the log format string in depth.
7840
7841 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7842 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7843
7844 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7845 log format to "rfc5424".
7846
7847 Example :
7848 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7849
7850
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007851log-tag <string>
7852 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7853 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7854 yes | yes | yes | yes
7855
7856 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7857 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007858 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007859 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7860 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7861 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7862 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7863 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7864 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007865
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007866max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7867 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7868 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7869 yes | no | yes | yes
7870
7871 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7872 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7873 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7874 servers.
7875
7876 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007877 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007878 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7879 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7880 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007881 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007882 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7883 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7884 picking a different server.
7885
7886 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7887 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7888 even if they have to be queued.
7889
7890 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7891 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7892
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007893max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7894 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7895 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7896 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007897
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007898maxconn <conns>
7899 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7901 yes | yes | yes | no
7902 Arguments :
7903 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7904 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7905 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7906 closes.
7907
7908 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007909 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007910 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7911 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007912 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7913 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7914 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7915 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007916
7917 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7918 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7919 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7920
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007921 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7922 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007923
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007924 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7925
7926
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007927mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007928 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7930 yes | yes | yes | yes
7931 Arguments :
7932 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7933 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7934 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7935 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7936
7937 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7938 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7939 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7940 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7941 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7942
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007943 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7944 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7945 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007946
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007947 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007948 defaults http_instances
7949 mode http
7950
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007951
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007952monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007953 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7955 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007956 Arguments :
7957 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7958 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007959 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007960 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7961 backend and its backup.
7962
7963 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7964 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7965 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7966 servers in a list of backends.
7967
7968 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7969 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7970 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007971 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007972 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7973 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007974 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007975 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7976 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007977
7978 Example:
7979 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007980 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007981 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7982 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7983 monitor-uri /site_alive
7984 monitor fail if site_dead
7985
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007986 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007987
7988
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007989monitor-uri <uri>
7990 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7992 yes | yes | yes | no
7993 Arguments :
7994 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7995 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7996
7997 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7998 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7999 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8000 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8001 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8002 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8003 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8004 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8005
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008006 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008007 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8008 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8009 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8010 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8011 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8012 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008013
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008014 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8015 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8016 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8017 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8018
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008019 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008020 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008021 frontend www
8022 mode http
8023 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8024
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008025 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008026
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008027
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008028option abortonclose
8029no option abortonclose
8030 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8032 yes | no | yes | yes
8033 Arguments : none
8034
8035 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8036 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8037 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8038 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008039 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008040 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8041 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8042 encountered while delivering the response.
8043
8044 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8045 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8046 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8047 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8048 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8049 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008050 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008051 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008052 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008053 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8054 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8055 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8056
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008057 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8058 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008059 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8060 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8061 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8062 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8063 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8064 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008065 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008066
8067 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8068 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8069
8070 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8071
8072
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008073option accept-invalid-http-request
8074no option accept-invalid-http-request
8075 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8077 yes | yes | yes | no
8078 Arguments : none
8079
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008080 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008081 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008082 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008083 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8084 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8085 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8086 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8087 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008088 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8089 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8090 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8091 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008092 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008093 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008094 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8095 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8096 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008097
8098 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8099 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8100 been confirmed.
8101
8102 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8103 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008104 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8105 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008106 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8107
8108 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8109 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8110
8111 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8112 stats socket.
8113
8114
8115option accept-invalid-http-response
8116no option accept-invalid-http-response
8117 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8119 yes | no | yes | yes
8120 Arguments : none
8121
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008122 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008123 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008124 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008125 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8126 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8127 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8128 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8129 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008130 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8131 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8132 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008133
8134 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8135 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8136 been confirmed.
8137
8138 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8139 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8140 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8141 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8142
8143 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8144 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8145
8146 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8147 stats socket.
8148
8149
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008150option allbackups
8151no option allbackups
8152 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8154 yes | no | yes | yes
8155 Arguments : none
8156
8157 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8158 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8159 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8160 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8161 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8162 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8163 order between the backup servers anymore.
8164
8165 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8166 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8167
8168 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8169 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8170
8171
8172option checkcache
8173no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008174 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8176 yes | no | yes | yes
8177 Arguments : none
8178
8179 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8180 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008181 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008182 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8183 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008184 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008185
8186 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008187 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008188 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008189 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8190 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008191 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008192 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008193 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8194 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008195 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008196 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8197 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008198 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008199 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8200 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8201 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8202 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8203 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8204 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8205 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8206 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8207 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8208
8209 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008210 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8211 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8212 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8213 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008214
8215 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8216 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008217 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008218 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008219
8220 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8221 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8222
8223
8224option clitcpka
8225no option clitcpka
8226 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8228 yes | yes | yes | no
8229 Arguments : none
8230
8231 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8232 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008233 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008234 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8235
8236 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8237 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8238 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8239 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8240
8241 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8242 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8243 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8244 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8245 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8246
8247 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8248
8249 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8250 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8251 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8252
8253 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8254 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8255
8256 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8257
8258
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008259option contstats
8260 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8262 yes | yes | yes | no
8263 Arguments : none
8264
8265 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8266 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8267 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008268 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008269 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8270 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8271 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8272 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8273 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008274
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008275option disable-h2-upgrade
8276no option disable-h2-upgrade
8277 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8278 connection.
8279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8280 yes | yes | yes | no
8281 Arguments : none
8282
8283 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8284 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8285 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8286 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008287 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8288 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8289 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8290 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8291 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8292 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008293
8294 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8295 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008296
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008297option dontlog-normal
8298no option dontlog-normal
8299 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8301 yes | yes | yes | no
8302 Arguments : none
8303
8304 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8305 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8306 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8307 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8308 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8309 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8310 logged.
8311
8312 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8313 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8314 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8315
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008316 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008317 logging.
8318
8319
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008320option dontlognull
8321no option dontlognull
8322 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8324 yes | yes | yes | no
8325 Arguments : none
8326
8327 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8328 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8329 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8330 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8331 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8332 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008333 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8334 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8335 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008336
8337 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008338 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008339 would not be logged.
8340
8341 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8342 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8343
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008344 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008345 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008346
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008347
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008348option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008349 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8351 yes | yes | yes | yes
8352 Arguments :
8353 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8354 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008355 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008356 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008357
8358 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8359 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8360 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8361 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8362 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8363 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8364 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008365 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8366 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8367 possible that the client has already brought one.
8368
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008369 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008370 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008371 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008372 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008373 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008374 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008375
8376 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8377 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8378 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8379 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8380 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8381 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008382 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008383
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008384 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8385 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008386 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008387 are under the control of the end-user.
8388
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008389 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008390 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8391 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008392 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8393 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8394 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008395
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008396 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008397 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8398 frontend www
8399 mode http
8400 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8401
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008402 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8403 backend www
8404 mode http
8405 option forwardfor header X-Client
8406
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008407 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008408 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008409
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008410
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008411option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8412no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8413 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8415 yes | yes | yes | no
8416 Arguments : none
8417
8418 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8419 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8420 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8421 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8422 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8423 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8424 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8425
8426 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8427 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8428 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8429 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8430 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8431 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8432 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8433 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8434 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8435 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8436
8437 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8438
8439 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8440 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8441
8442 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8443 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8444
8445
8446option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8447no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8448 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8450 yes | no | yes | yes
8451 Arguments : none
8452
8453 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8454 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8455 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8456 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8457 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8458 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8459 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8460
8461 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8462 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8463 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8464 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8465 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8466 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8467 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8468 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8469 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8470 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8471
8472 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8473
8474 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8475 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8476
8477 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8478 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8479
8480
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008481option http-buffer-request
8482no option http-buffer-request
8483 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8485 yes | yes | yes | yes
8486 Arguments : none
8487
8488 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8489 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8490 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8491 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8492 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8493 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008494 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8495 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8496 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8497 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008498
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008499 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8500 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008501
8502
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008503option http-ignore-probes
8504no option http-ignore-probes
8505 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8507 yes | yes | yes | no
8508 Arguments : none
8509
8510 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8511 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8512 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8513 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8514 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8515 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8516 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8517 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8518 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008519 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8520 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008521 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8522
8523 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8524 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8525 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8526 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8527 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8528 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8529 are often the only way to detect them.
8530
8531 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8532 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8533
8534 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8535
8536
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008537option http-keep-alive
8538no option http-keep-alive
8539 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8541 yes | yes | yes | yes
8542 Arguments : none
8543
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008544 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8545 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008546 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8547 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008548 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8549 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8550 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008551
8552 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8553 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008554 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8555 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8556 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8557 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8558 situations where this option may be useful :
8559
8560 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008561 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008562
8563 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8564 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8565
8566 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8567 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8568 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8569 request.
8570
8571 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8572 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008573 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8574 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8575 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008576
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008577 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8578 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8579 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8580 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8581 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8582 not set.
8583
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008584 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8585 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8586 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008587
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008588 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008589 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008590 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008591
8592
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008593option http-no-delay
8594no option http-no-delay
8595 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8597 yes | yes | yes | yes
8598 Arguments : none
8599
8600 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8601 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8602 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8603 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8604 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8605 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8606 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008607 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008608 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8609 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8610 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8611 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8612 affected.
8613
8614 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8615 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8616 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8617 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8618 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8619 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8620 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8621 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8622 latency environments.
8623
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008624 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8625
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008626
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008627option http-pretend-keepalive
8628no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008629 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008631 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008632 Arguments : none
8633
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008634 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008635 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8636 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8637 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008638 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008639 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8640 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8641 consider the response complete.
8642
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008643 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008644 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008645 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008646 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008647 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008648 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8649
8650 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8651 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8652 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8653 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008654 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8655 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008656 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8657
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008658 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8659 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8660 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8661 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8662 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8663 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008664
8665 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8666 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8667
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008668 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008669 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008670
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008671
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008672option http-server-close
8673no option http-server-close
8674 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8676 yes | yes | yes | yes
8677 Arguments : none
8678
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008679 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8680 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8681 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8682 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008683 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8684 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8685 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8686 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8687 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8688 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8689 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8690 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8691 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8692 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8693 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008694
8695 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8696 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8697 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8698 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008699 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8700 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008701
8702 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8703 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008704 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8705 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8706 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008707
8708 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8709 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8710
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008711 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8712 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008713
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008714option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008715no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008716 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8718 yes | yes | yes | no
8719 Arguments : none
8720
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008721 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008722 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8723 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8724 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8725 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8726 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008727 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008728
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008729 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008730 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008731 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8732 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8733 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008734
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008735 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8736 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8737 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8738 front of an existing proxy.
8739
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008740 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8741
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008742 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008743
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008744option httpchk
8745option httpchk <uri>
8746option httpchk <method> <uri>
8747option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008748 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8750 yes | no | yes | yes
8751 Arguments :
8752 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8753 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8754 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8755 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8756 ones.
8757
8758 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8759 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8760 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8761
8762 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8763 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8764 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008765 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008766
8767 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8768 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8769 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8770 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8771 the lack of any response.
8772
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008773 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8774 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8775 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8776 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8777
8778 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8779 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8780 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008781
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008782 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8783 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008784 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008785 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008786 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008787
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008788 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8789 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8790 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8791 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8792
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008793 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008794 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8795 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8796 backend https_relay
8797 mode tcp
8798 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8799 http-check send hdr Host www
8800 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008801
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008802 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8803 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8804 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008805
8806
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008807option httpclose
8808no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008809 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8811 yes | yes | yes | yes
8812 Arguments : none
8813
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008814 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8815 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8816 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8817 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008818 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008819
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008820 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8821 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008822 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008823 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8824 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008825
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008826 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8827 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8828 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008829
8830 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8831 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008832 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8833 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8834 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008835
8836 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8837 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8838
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008839 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008840
8841
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008842option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008843 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008845 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008846 Arguments :
8847 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8848 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8849 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008850 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008851 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008852
8853 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8854 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8855 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8856 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8857 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8858 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8859 ports.
8860
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008861 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8862 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008863
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008864 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8865
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008866 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008867
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02008868option httpslog
8869 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
8870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8871 yes | yes | yes | no
8872
8873 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8874 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8875 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8876 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8877 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8878 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
8879 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
8880
8881 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8882
8883 See also : section 8 about logging.
8884
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008885
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008886option independent-streams
8887no option independent-streams
8888 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8890 yes | yes | yes | yes
8891 Arguments : none
8892
8893 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8894 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8895 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8896 receive data or not.
8897
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008898 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008899 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8900 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8901 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8902 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8903 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8904 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8905 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8906 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8907 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8908 socket buffers.
8909
8910 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8911 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8912 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8913 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8914 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8915
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008916 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008917
8918
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008919option ldap-check
8920 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8922 yes | no | yes | yes
8923 Arguments : none
8924
8925 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8926 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8927 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8928 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8929
8930 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8931 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8932
8933 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8934 configure it.
8935
8936 Example :
8937 option ldap-check
8938
8939 See also : "option httpchk"
8940
8941
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008942option external-check
8943 Use external processes for server health checks
8944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8945 yes | no | yes | yes
8946
8947 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8948 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8949 command".
8950
8951 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8952
8953 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8954
8955
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008956option log-health-checks
8957no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008958 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8960 yes | no | yes | yes
8961 Arguments : none
8962
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008963 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8964 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8965 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008966
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008967 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8968 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8969 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8970 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8971 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8972
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008973 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008974 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008975
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008976 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8977 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8978 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008979
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008980
8981option log-separate-errors
8982no option log-separate-errors
8983 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8985 yes | yes | yes | no
8986 Arguments : none
8987
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008988 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008989 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8990 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8991 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8992 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8993 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8994 provides very important information.
8995
8996 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8997 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8998 error logs.
8999
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009000 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009001 logging.
9002
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009003
9004option logasap
9005no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009006 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9008 yes | yes | yes | no
9009 Arguments : none
9010
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009011 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9012 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9013 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9014 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9015
9016 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9017 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9018 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9019 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9020 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009021 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009022 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9023 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9024 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9025 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009026 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009027
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009028 Examples :
9029 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9030 mode http
9031 option httplog
9032 option logasap
9033 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9034
9035 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9036 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9037 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9038 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9039
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009040 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009041 logging.
9042
9043
William Lallemand56f1f752021-08-02 10:25:30 +02009044option log-error-via-logformat
9045no option log-error-via-logformat
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4a6328f2021-07-29 09:45:53 +02009046 Enable or disable dedicated connection error logging.
9047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9048 yes | yes | yes | no
9049 Arguments : none
9050
9051 In case of connection error, if the option is disabled, a log line following
9052 the format described in section 8.2.6, the legacy format, will be emitted.
9053 Otherwise, a log line following the configured log-format for the listener
9054 will be emitted. The error code and the corresponding message found in the
9055 error log can be added to a log-format thanks to the "fc_conn_err" and
9056 "fc_conn_err_str" sample fetches.
9057
9058 See also : "option httpslog" and section 8 about logging.
9059
9060
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009061option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009062 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9064 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009065 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009066 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9067 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009068 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9069 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009070
9071 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9072 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009073 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009074 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009075 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9076 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9077 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009078
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009079 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9080 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9081 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009082
9083 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009084 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009085 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9086 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9087 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9088 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9089 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9090 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9091 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9092
9093 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9094 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009095
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009096 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009097
9098 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9099 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9100 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9101 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009102 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009103 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009104
9105 See also: "option httpchk"
9106
9107
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009108option nolinger
9109no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009110 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009111 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9112 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009113 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009114
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009115 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009116 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9117 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9118 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9119 connections.
9120
9121 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9122 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009123 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9124 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9125 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9126 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9127 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9128 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9129 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9130 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9131 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9132 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9133 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9134 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9135 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009136
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009137 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9138 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9139 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9140 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9141 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009142
9143 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9144 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009145 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009146 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009147 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009148
9149 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9150 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9151
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009152 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9153 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009154
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009155option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9156 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9158 yes | yes | yes | yes
9159 Arguments :
9160 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9161 matching <network>
9162 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9163 header name.
9164
9165 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9166 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9167 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9168 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9169 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9170 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9171 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9172 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9173 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9174 possible that the client has already brought one.
9175
9176 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9177 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9178 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9179 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9180 header and requires different one.
9181
9182 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9183 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9184 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009185 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9186 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9187 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9188 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9189 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009190
9191 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9192 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9193 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9194 both are defined.
9195
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009196 Examples :
9197 # Original Destination address
9198 frontend www
9199 mode http
9200 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9201
9202 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9203 backend www
9204 mode http
9205 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9206
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009207 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009208
9209
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009210option persist
9211no option persist
9212 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9213 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9214 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009215 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009216
9217 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9218 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9219 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9220 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9221 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9222 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9223 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9224 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9225 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9226 redirected to another valid server.
9227
9228 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9229 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9230
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009231 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009232
9233
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009234option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9235 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9237 yes | no | yes | yes
9238 Arguments :
9239 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9240 PostgreSQL server.
9241
9242 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9243 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9244 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9245 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9246
9247 See also: "option httpchk"
9248
9249
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009250option prefer-last-server
9251no option prefer-last-server
9252 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9253 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9254 yes | no | yes | yes
9255 Arguments : none
9256
9257 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009258 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009259 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9260 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009261 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009262 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009263 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009264 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9265 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009266 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009267 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009268 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9269 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9270 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009271 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9272 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9273 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009274
9275 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9276 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9277
9278 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9279
9280
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009281option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009282option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009283no option redispatch
9284 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9285 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9286 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009287 Arguments :
9288 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9289 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9290 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009291 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009292 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009293 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009294 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9295 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9296 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9297
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009298
9299 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9300 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9301 be able to access the service anymore.
9302
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009303 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9304 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009305
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009306 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9307 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9308 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9309 following order:
9310
9311 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9312
9313 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9314 list, or
9315
9316 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9317
9318 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9319 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9320
9321 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9322 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9323 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9324 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9325
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009326 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009327 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9328 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009329
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009330 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9331 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9332
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009333 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009334
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009335
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009336option redis-check
9337 Use redis health checks for server testing
9338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9339 yes | no | yes | yes
9340 Arguments : none
9341
9342 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9343 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9344 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9345 find the "+PONG" response message.
9346
9347 Example :
9348 option redis-check
9349
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009350 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009351
9352
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009353option smtpchk
9354option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9355 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9357 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009358 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009359 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009360 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009361 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9362
9363 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9364 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9365 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9366
9367 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9368 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9369 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9370 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9371 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9372 dead server.
9373
9374 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9375 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009376 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009377 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9378
9379 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9380 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9381 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9382 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009383 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009384
9385 Example :
9386 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9387
9388 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9389
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009390
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009391option socket-stats
9392no option socket-stats
9393
9394 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9396 yes | yes | yes | no
9397
9398 Arguments : none
9399
9400
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009401option splice-auto
9402no option splice-auto
9403 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9405 yes | yes | yes | yes
9406 Arguments : none
9407
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009408 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009409 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009410 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009411 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009412 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009413 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9414 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9415 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9416 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9417
9418 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9419 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9420 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9421 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9422 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9423 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9424 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9425 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9426 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9427 keyword.
9428
9429 Example :
9430 option splice-auto
9431
9432 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9433 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9434
9435 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9436 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9437
9438
9439option splice-request
9440no option splice-request
9441 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9443 yes | yes | yes | yes
9444 Arguments : none
9445
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009446 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009447 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009448 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9449 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9450 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9451 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9452
9453 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9454
9455 Example :
9456 option splice-request
9457
9458 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9459 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9460
9461 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9462 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9463
9464
9465option splice-response
9466no option splice-response
9467 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9469 yes | yes | yes | yes
9470 Arguments : none
9471
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009472 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009473 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009474 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9475 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9476 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9477 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9478
9479 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9480
9481 Example :
9482 option splice-response
9483
9484 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9485 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9486
9487 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9488 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9489
9490
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009491option spop-check
9492 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9494 no | no | no | yes
9495 Arguments : none
9496
9497 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9498 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9499 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9500 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9501
9502 Example :
9503 option spop-check
9504
9505 See also : "option httpchk"
9506
9507
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009508option srvtcpka
9509no option srvtcpka
9510 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9512 yes | no | yes | yes
9513 Arguments : none
9514
9515 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9516 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009517 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009518 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9519
9520 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9521 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9522 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9523 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9524
9525 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9526 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9527 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9528 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9529 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9530
9531 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9532
9533 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9534 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9535 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9536
9537 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9538 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9539
9540 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9541
9542
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009543option ssl-hello-chk
9544 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9546 yes | no | yes | yes
9547 Arguments : none
9548
9549 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9550 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9551 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9552 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9553 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9554 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9555 hello message.
9556
9557 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9558 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9559 messages, which is appreciable.
9560
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009561 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009562 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9563 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009564
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009565 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9566
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009567
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009568option tcp-check
9569 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9570 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9571 yes | no | yes | yes
9572
9573 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9574 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9575
9576 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9577 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9578 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9579
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009580 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009581 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9582 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9583 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9584 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9585 only.
9586
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009587 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009588 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009589 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9590 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9591 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9592
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009593 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009594 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9595 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009596 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009597 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9598 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9599 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9600 the respective protocols.
9601 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009602 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009603
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009604 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009605
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009606 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9607 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9608 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9609 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009610
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009611 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9612 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9613 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009614
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009615
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009616 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009617 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009618 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009619 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009620
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009621 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009622 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009623 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009624
9625 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9626 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009627 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009628 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009629 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009630 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009631 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009632 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009633 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9634 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009635 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009636 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9637 tcp-check expect string +OK
9638
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009639 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009640 (send many headers before analyzing)
9641 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009642 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009643 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9644 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9645 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9646 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009647 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009648
9649
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009650 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009651
9652
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009653option tcp-smart-accept
9654no option tcp-smart-accept
9655 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9657 yes | yes | yes | no
9658 Arguments : none
9659
9660 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9661 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9662 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9663 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9664 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9665 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9666
9667 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9668 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9669 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9670 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9671
9672 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9673 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9674 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009675 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009676
9677 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9678 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9679 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9680
9681 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9682 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9683 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9684
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009685 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9686
9687
9688option tcp-smart-connect
9689no option tcp-smart-connect
9690 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9692 yes | no | yes | yes
9693 Arguments : none
9694
9695 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9696 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9697 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9698 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9699 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9700
9701 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9702 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9703 complex.
9704
9705 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9706 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9707 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9708
9709 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9710 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9711
9712 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9713
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009714
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009715option tcpka
9716 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9718 yes | yes | yes | yes
9719 Arguments : none
9720
9721 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9722 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009723 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009724 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9725
9726 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9727 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9728 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9729 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9730
9731 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9732 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9733 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9734 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9735 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9736
9737 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9738
9739 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9740 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9741 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9742 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9743 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9744 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9745 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9746 backends.
9747
9748 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9749
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009750
9751option tcplog
9752 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009754 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009755 Arguments : none
9756
9757 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9758 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9759 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9760 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9761 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9762 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9763 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9764 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9765
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009766 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9767
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009768 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009769
9770
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009771option transparent
9772no option transparent
9773 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009775 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009776 Arguments : none
9777
9778 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9779 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9780 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9781 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9782 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9783 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9784 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9785 appropriate server.
9786
9787 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9788 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9789
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009790 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009791 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009792
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009793
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009794external-check command <command>
9795 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9797 yes | no | yes | yes
9798
9799 Arguments :
9800 <command> is the external command to run
9801
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009802 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9803
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009804 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009805
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009806 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9807 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9808 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9809 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9810 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9811 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009812
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009813 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9814
9815 Environment variables :
9816 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9817 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9818
9819 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9820
9821 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9822
9823 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9824 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9825 for a UNIX socket).
9826
9827 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9828
9829 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9830
9831 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9832
9833 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9834
9835 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9836
9837 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9838 socket).
9839
9840 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9841 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9842
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009843 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9844
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009845 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9846 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9847 failed.
9848
9849 Example :
9850 external-check command /bin/true
9851
9852 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9853
9854
9855external-check path <path>
9856 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9858 yes | no | yes | yes
9859
9860 Arguments :
9861 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9862
9863 The default path is "".
9864
9865 Example :
9866 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9867
9868 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9869 "external-check command"
9870
9871
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009872persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009873persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009874 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9876 yes | no | yes | yes
9877 Arguments :
9878 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009879 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9880 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009881
9882 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9883 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009884 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009885 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9886 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9887 forwarded to this server.
9888
9889 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9890 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9891 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009892 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009893 a single "listen" section.
9894
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009895 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9896 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9897 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9898
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009899 Example :
9900 listen tse-farm
9901 bind :3389
9902 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9903 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9904 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9905 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9906 persist rdp-cookie
9907 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009908 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009909 balance rdp-cookie
9910 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9911 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9912
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009913 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9914 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009915
9916
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009917rate-limit sessions <rate>
9918 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9920 yes | yes | yes | no
9921 Arguments :
9922 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9923 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9924
9925 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9926 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9927 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009928 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009929 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9930 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9931
9932 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9933 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9934 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9935 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9936
9937 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9938 listen smtp
9939 mode tcp
9940 bind :25
9941 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009942 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009943
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009944 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9945 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9946 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009947
9948 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9949
9950
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009951redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9952redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9953redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009954 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9956 no | yes | yes | yes
9957
9958 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009959 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009960
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009961 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009962 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009963 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9964 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9965 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009966
9967 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9968 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9969 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9970 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9971 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009972 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9973 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9974 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9975 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009976
9977 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9978 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9979 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9980 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9981 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9982 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009983 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009984 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009985 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9986 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9987 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009988
9989 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009990 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9991 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9992 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009993 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009994 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9995 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9996 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9997 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009998
9999 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010000 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010001
10002 - "drop-query"
10003 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10004 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10005 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10006 with a location-type redirect.
10007
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010008 - "append-slash"
10009 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10010 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10011 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10012 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10013
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010014 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10015 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10016 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10017 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10018 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10019 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10020 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10021
10022 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10023 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10024 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10025 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10026 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10027 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10028 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010029
10030 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10031 acl clear dst_port 80
10032 acl secure dst_port 8080
10033 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010034 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010035 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010036 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10037
10038 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010039 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10040 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10041 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010042 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010043
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010044 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10045 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10046 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10047
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010048 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010049 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010050
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010051 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010052 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10053 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10054 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010055
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010056 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010057
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010058
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010059retries <value>
10060 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10061 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10062 yes | no | yes | yes
10063 Arguments :
10064 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10065 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10066 default value is 3.
10067
10068 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10069 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10070 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10071
10072 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010073 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10074 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010075
10076 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10077 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10078
10079 See also : "option redispatch"
10080
10081
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010082retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010083 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10084 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10085 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010086 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10087 yes | no | yes | yes
10088 Arguments :
10089 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
10090 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
10091 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
10092 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
10093
10094 none never retry
10095
10096 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10097 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10098
10099 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10100 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10101 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10102 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10103 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10104 processing the request.
10105
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010106 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10107 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10108 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10109 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10110 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10111 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10112 overflow attack for example).
10113
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010114 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10115 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10116 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10117 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10118 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10119 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10120 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10121 amplify denial of service attacks.
10122
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010123 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10124 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10125 considered to be safe to retry.
10126
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010127 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10128 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10129 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10130 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10131 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010132
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010133 all-retryable-errors
10134 retry request for any error that are considered
10135 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10136 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10137 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10138
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010139 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10140 not cumulative.
10141
10142 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10143 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10144 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10145 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10146
10147 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10148 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10149 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10150 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10151 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10152 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10153 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10154 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10155 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10156 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10157 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10158 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10159
10160 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10161 should not use this directive.
10162
10163 The default is "conn-failure".
10164
10165 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10166
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010167server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010168 Declare a server in a backend
10169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10170 no | no | yes | yes
10171 Arguments :
10172 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010173 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010174 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010175
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010176 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10177 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10178 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10179 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010180 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10181 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010182 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010183 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10184 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010185 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10186 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10187 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10188 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10189 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10190 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10191 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010192 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010193 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10194 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10195 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10196 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10197 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10198 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010199 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10200 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010201 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10202 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010203
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010204 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010205 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10206 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10207 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10208 adding this value to the client's port.
10209
10210 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10211 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010212 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010213
10214 Examples :
10215 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10216 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010217 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010218 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10219 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10220 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010221
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010222 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10223 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10224 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10225 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10226 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10227
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010228 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10229 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010230
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010231server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010232 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010233 this backend.
10234 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10235 no | no | yes | yes
10236
10237 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10238 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10239 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10240 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10241 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010242
10243 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10244 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10245
10246 global
10247 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10248
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010249 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010250 load-server-state-from-file
10251
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010252 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010253 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010254
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010255server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10256 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10257 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10259 no | no | yes | yes
10260
10261 Arguments:
10262 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10263
10264 <num | range>
10265 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10266 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10267 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10268 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10269
10270 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10271
10272 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10273
10274 <params*>
10275 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10276 keyword.
10277
10278 Examples:
10279 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10280 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10281 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10282
10283 # or
10284 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10285
10286 # would be equivalent to:
10287 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10288 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10289 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10290
10291
10292
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010293source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010294source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010295source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010296 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10298 yes | no | yes | yes
10299 Arguments :
10300 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10301 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010302
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010303 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010304 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10305 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10306 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10307 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10308 supported prefixes are :
10309 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10310 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10311 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010312 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010313 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10314 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010315
10316 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10317 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010318 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10319 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10320 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010321
10322 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10323 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10324 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10325 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10326 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10327 <addr>.
10328
10329 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10330 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10331 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10332 port.
10333
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010334 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10335 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10336 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10337 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010338 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010339 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10340 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10341 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10342 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10343 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10344 HTTP header.
10345
10346 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10347 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010348 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010349 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10350 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10351 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10352 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10353 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10354 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10355 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10356
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010357 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10358 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10359 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10360 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10361 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10362 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10363
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010364 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10365 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10366 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10367 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10368
10369 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10370 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10371 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10372 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10373 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10374 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10375
10376 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10377 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10378 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10379 there are two methods :
10380
10381 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10382 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10383 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10384 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10385 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10386 of the client ranges may be used.
10387
10388 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10389 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10390 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10391 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10392 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10393 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10394 same session.
10395
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010396 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10397 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10398 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010399 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010400
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010401 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10402
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010403 Examples :
10404 backend private
10405 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10406 source 192.168.1.200
10407
10408 backend transparent_ssl1
10409 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10410 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10411
10412 backend transparent_ssl2
10413 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10414 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10415 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10416
10417 backend transparent_ssl3
10418 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10419 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10420 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10421
10422 backend transparent_smtp
10423 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10424 # with Tproxy version 4.
10425 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10426
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010427 backend transparent_http
10428 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10429 # proxy.
10430 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10431
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010432 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010433 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10434
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010435
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010436srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10437 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10438 the connection on the server side.
10439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10440 yes | no | yes | yes
10441 Arguments :
10442 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10443
10444 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10445 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010446 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10447 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010448
10449 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10450
10451
10452srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10453 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10454 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10455 server side.
10456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10457 yes | no | yes | yes
10458 Arguments :
10459 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10460 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10461 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10462 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10463
10464 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10465 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010466 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10467 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010468
10469 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10470
10471
10472srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10473 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10475 yes | no | yes | yes
10476 Arguments :
10477 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10478 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10479 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10480 document.
10481
10482 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10483 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010484 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10485 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010486
10487 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10488
10489
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010490stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10491 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010493 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010494
10495 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10496 matched.
10497
10498 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10499 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10500
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010501 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10502 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10503 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10504 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010505
10506 Example :
10507 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10508 backend stats_localhost
10509 stats enable
10510 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10511
10512 Example :
10513 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10514 backend stats_auth
10515 stats enable
10516 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10517 stats admin if TRUE
10518
10519 Example :
10520 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10521 userlist stats-auth
10522 group admin users admin
10523 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10524 group readonly users haproxy
10525 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10526
10527 backend stats_auth
10528 stats enable
10529 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10530 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10531 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10532 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10533
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020010534 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
10535 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010536
10537
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010538stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10539 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010541 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010542 Arguments :
10543 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10544
10545 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10546
10547 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10548 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10549 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10550 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10551 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10552 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10553
10554 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10555 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10556 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010557 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010558
10559 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10560 report using "stats scope".
10561
10562 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10563 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10564 unobvious parameters.
10565
10566 Example :
10567 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10568 backend public_www
10569 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10570 stats enable
10571 stats hide-version
10572 stats scope .
10573 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010574 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010575 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10576 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10577
10578 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10579 backend private_monitoring
10580 stats enable
10581 stats uri /admin?stats
10582 stats refresh 5s
10583
10584 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10585
10586
10587stats enable
10588 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010590 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010591 Arguments : none
10592
10593 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10594 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10595 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10596 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10597 - stats auth : no authentication
10598 - stats scope : no restriction
10599
10600 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10601 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10602 unobvious parameters.
10603
10604 Example :
10605 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10606 backend public_www
10607 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10608 stats enable
10609 stats hide-version
10610 stats scope .
10611 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010612 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010613 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10614 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10615
10616 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10617 backend private_monitoring
10618 stats enable
10619 stats uri /admin?stats
10620 stats refresh 5s
10621
10622 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10623
10624
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010625stats hide-version
10626 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010628 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010629 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010630
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010631 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10632 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10633 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10634 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10635 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10636 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010637
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010638 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10639 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10640 unobvious parameters.
10641
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010642 Example :
10643 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10644 backend public_www
10645 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010646 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010647 stats hide-version
10648 stats scope .
10649 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010650 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010651 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10652 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010653
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010654 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10655 backend private_monitoring
10656 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010657 stats uri /admin?stats
10658 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010659
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010660 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010661
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010662
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010663stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10664 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10665 Access control for statistics
10666
10667 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10668 no | no | yes | yes
10669
10670 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10671 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10672 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10673 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10674 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10675 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10676
10677 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10678 instance.
10679
10680 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10681 about ACL usage.
10682
10683
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010684stats realm <realm>
10685 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010687 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010688 Arguments :
10689 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10690 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10691 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10692
10693 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10694 using a backslash ('\').
10695
10696 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10697 only related to authentication.
10698
10699 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10700 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10701 unobvious parameters.
10702
10703 Example :
10704 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10705 backend public_www
10706 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10707 stats enable
10708 stats hide-version
10709 stats scope .
10710 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010711 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010712 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10713 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10714
10715 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10716 backend private_monitoring
10717 stats enable
10718 stats uri /admin?stats
10719 stats refresh 5s
10720
10721 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10722
10723
10724stats refresh <delay>
10725 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010727 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010728 Arguments :
10729 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10730 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10731 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10732 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10733 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10734 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10735
10736 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10737 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10738 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010739 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010740
10741 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10742 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10743 unobvious parameters.
10744
10745 Example :
10746 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10747 backend public_www
10748 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10749 stats enable
10750 stats hide-version
10751 stats scope .
10752 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010753 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010754 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10755 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10756
10757 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10758 backend private_monitoring
10759 stats enable
10760 stats uri /admin?stats
10761 stats refresh 5s
10762
10763 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10764
10765
10766stats scope { <name> | "." }
10767 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010769 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010770 Arguments :
10771 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10772 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10773 section in which the statement appears.
10774
10775 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10776 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10777 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10778 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10779 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10780 exists.
10781
10782 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10783 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10784 unobvious parameters.
10785
10786 Example :
10787 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10788 backend public_www
10789 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10790 stats enable
10791 stats hide-version
10792 stats scope .
10793 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010794 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010795 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10796 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10797
10798 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10799 backend private_monitoring
10800 stats enable
10801 stats uri /admin?stats
10802 stats refresh 5s
10803
10804 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10805
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010806
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010807stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010808 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010810 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010811
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010812 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010813 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10814
10815 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10816 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10817
10818 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10819 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010820 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010821
10822 Example :
10823 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10824 backend private_monitoring
10825 stats enable
10826 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10827 stats uri /admin?stats
10828 stats refresh 5s
10829
10830 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10831 global section.
10832
10833
10834stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010835 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10837 yes | yes | yes | yes
10838 Arguments : none
10839
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010840 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010841 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10842 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10843 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10844 - IP (socket, server)
10845 - cookie (backend, server)
10846
10847 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10848 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010849 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010850
10851 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10852
10853
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010854stats show-modules
10855 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10857 yes | yes | yes | yes
10858 Arguments : none
10859
10860 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10861 values as a tooltip.
10862
10863 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10864 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10865 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10866
10867 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10868
10869
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010870stats show-node [ <name> ]
10871 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010873 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010874 Arguments:
10875 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10876 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10877
10878 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10879 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010880 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010881
10882 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10883 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10884 unobvious parameters.
10885
10886 Example:
10887 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10888 backend private_monitoring
10889 stats enable
10890 stats show-node Europe-1
10891 stats uri /admin?stats
10892 stats refresh 5s
10893
10894 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10895 section.
10896
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010897
10898stats uri <prefix>
10899 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010901 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010902 Arguments :
10903 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10904 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10905 query string.
10906
10907 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10908 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10909 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10910 possible to reach it in the application.
10911
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010912 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010913 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010914 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10915 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10916 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10917 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10918
10919 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10920 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10921 an address or a port to statistics only.
10922
10923 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10924 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10925 unobvious parameters.
10926
10927 Example :
10928 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10929 backend public_www
10930 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10931 stats enable
10932 stats hide-version
10933 stats scope .
10934 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010935 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010936 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10937 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10938
10939 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10940 backend private_monitoring
10941 stats enable
10942 stats uri /admin?stats
10943 stats refresh 5s
10944
10945 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10946
10947
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010948stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10949 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010951 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010952
10953 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010954 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010955 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010956 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010957 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10958
10959 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10960 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10961 the "stick-table" statement.
10962
10963 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10964 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10965 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10966 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10967 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10968
10969 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10970 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10971 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10972 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10973 transformation rules.
10974
10975 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10976 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10977 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10978 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10979 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10980 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10981 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10982
10983 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10984 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10985 ACL based conditions.
10986
10987 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10988 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10989 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10990 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10991
10992 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10993 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10994 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10995 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10996
10997 Example :
10998 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10999 # last 30 minutes
11000 backend pop
11001 mode tcp
11002 balance roundrobin
11003 stick store-request src
11004 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11005 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11006 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11007
11008 backend smtp
11009 mode tcp
11010 balance roundrobin
11011 stick match src table pop
11012 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11013 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11014
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011015 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
11016 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011017
11018
11019stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11020 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11022 no | no | yes | yes
11023
11024 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11025 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11026 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11027 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11028
11029 Examples :
11030 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011031 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011032
11033 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11034 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11035 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11036
11037
11038 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11039 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11040 backend http
11041 mode http
11042 balance roundrobin
11043 stick on src table https
11044 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11045 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11046 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11047
11048 backend https
11049 mode tcp
11050 balance roundrobin
11051 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11052 stick on src
11053 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11054 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11055
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011056 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011057
11058
11059stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11060 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11062 no | no | yes | yes
11063
11064 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011065 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011066 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011067 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011068 server is selected.
11069
11070 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11071 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11072 the "stick-table" statement.
11073
11074 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11075 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11076 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11077 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11078 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11079 address.
11080
11081 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11082 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11083 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11084 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11085 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11086 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11087 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11088 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11089 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11090 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11091
11092 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11093 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11094 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11095 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11096 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11097 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11098 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11099
11100 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11101 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11102 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11103 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11104
11105 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11106 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11107 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11108 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11109 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11110 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011111 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11112 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11113 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11114 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11115 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11116 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011117
11118 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11119 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11120 the request.
11121
11122 Example :
11123 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11124 # last 30 minutes
11125 backend pop
11126 mode tcp
11127 balance roundrobin
11128 stick store-request src
11129 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11130 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11131 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11132
11133 backend smtp
11134 mode tcp
11135 balance roundrobin
11136 stick match src table pop
11137 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11138 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11139
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011140 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011141
11142
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011143stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011144 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011145 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011146 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011148 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011149
11150 Arguments :
11151 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11152 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11153 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11154 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11155
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011156 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11157 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11158 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11159 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11160
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011161 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11162 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11163 instance.
11164
11165 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11166 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11167 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11168 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11169 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11170 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011171 to 32 characters.
11172
11173 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11174 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11175 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011176 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011177 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11178 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011179
11180 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011181 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11182 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011183 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11184 increase.
11185
11186 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011187 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11188 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11189 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011190
11191 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011192 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011193 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11194 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011195 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011196 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11197 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11198 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11199 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11200 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11201 parameter (see below).
11202
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011203 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11204 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11205 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11206 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11207 soft restart.
11208
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011209 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11210 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11211 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11212 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011213 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011214 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011215 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11216 if not expiration delay is specified.
11217
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011218 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11219 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11220 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11221 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11222 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11223 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11224 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11225 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11226 token.
11227
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011228 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11229 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11230 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11231 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011232 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11233 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11234 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11235 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11236 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11237 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11238 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11239 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11240 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11241 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11242 types and their arguments.
11243
11244 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11245 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11246 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11247 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11248
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011249 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
11250 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
11251 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
11252 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
11253 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
11254 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11255 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11256 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11257 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11258 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011259 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
11260 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
11261 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
11262 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011263
11264 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
11265 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
11266 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
11267 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
11268 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
11269 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
11270 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpc0 to gpc99,
11271 to ensure that the build of a peer update message can fit into the
11272 buffer. Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
11273 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
11274 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
11275 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011276 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
11277 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
11278 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
11279 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011280
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011281 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11282 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11283 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011284 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011285
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011286 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11287 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11288 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011289 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011290 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011291 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011292
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011293 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11294 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11295 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11296 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11297
11298 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11299 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11300 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11301 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11302 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11303 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11304
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011305 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
11306 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
11307 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
11308 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
11309 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
11310 elements: gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11311 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11312 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11313 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11314 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020011315 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
11316 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
11317 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011318
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011319 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11320 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11321 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11322 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11323
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011324 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11325 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11326 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11327 they were received.
11328
11329 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11330 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11331 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11332 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11333 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11334
11335 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11336 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11337 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11338 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11339 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11340
11341 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11342 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11343 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11344
11345 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11346 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11347 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11348 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11349 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11350
11351 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11352 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11353 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11354 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11355 the client side.
11356
11357 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11358 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11359 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11360 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11361 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11362 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11363 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11364
11365 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11366 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11367 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11368 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11369 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11370 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011371 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011372
11373 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11374 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11375 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11376 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11377 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11378 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11379
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011380 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11381 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11382 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11383 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11384 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11385
11386 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11387 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11388 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11389 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11390 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11391 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11392
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011393 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011394 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011395 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11396 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11397
11398 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11399 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11400 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11401 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11402 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11403 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11404 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11405 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11406 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11407 recommended for better fairness.
11408
11409 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011410 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011411 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11412 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11413
11414 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11415 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11416 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11417 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11418 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11419 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11420 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11421 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11422 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11423 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011424
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011425 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11426 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011427 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11428 reference it.
11429
11430 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11431 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011432 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11433 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11434 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011435
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011436 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11437 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11438 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11439 something that can be ignored.
11440
11441 Example:
11442 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11443 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11444 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11445 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11446
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011447 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011448 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011449
11450
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011451stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011452 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11454 no | no | yes | yes
11455
11456 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011457 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011458 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011459 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011460 server is selected.
11461
11462 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11463 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11464 the "stick-table" statement.
11465
11466 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11467 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11468 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11469 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11470
11471 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11472 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11473 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11474 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11475 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11476 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011477 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011478 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11479 rules.
11480
11481 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11482 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11483 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11484 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11485 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11486 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11487 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11488
11489 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11490 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11491 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11492 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11493
11494 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11495 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11496 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11497 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11498 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11499 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011500 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11501 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11502 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11503 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11504 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11505 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11506 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11507 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11508 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011509
11510 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11511
11512 Example :
11513 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11514 backend https
11515 mode tcp
11516 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011517 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011518 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011519
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011520 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11521 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11522
11523 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11524 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11525 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11526
11527 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11528 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011529
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011530 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11531 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11532 # at offset 44.
11533
11534 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11535 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11536
11537 # Learn on response if server hello.
11538 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011539
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011540 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11541 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11542
11543 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11544 extraction.
11545
11546
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011547tcp-check comment <string>
11548 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11549 it fails.
11550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11551 yes | no | yes | yes
11552
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011553 Arguments :
11554 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11555 rule fails.
11556
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011557 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11558 user-friendly error reporting.
11559
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011560 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11561 "tcp-check expect".
11562
11563
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011564tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11565 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011566 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011567 Opens a new connection
11568 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011569 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011570
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011571 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011572 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11573
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011574 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011575 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011576
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011577 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011578 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11579 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011580 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011581
11582 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011583
11584 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11585
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011586 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11587
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011588 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11589
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011590 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11591
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011592 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11593 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11594 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11595 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11596
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011597 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11598 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11599 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11600 haproxy -vv.
11601
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011602 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011603
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011604 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11605 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11606 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11607
11608 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11609 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11610 of the sequence.
11611
11612 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11613 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11614 do.
11615
11616 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11617 unset-var or comment rules.
11618
11619 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011620 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11621 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11622 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11623 option tcp-check
11624 tcp-check connect
11625 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11626 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11627 tcp-check send \r\n
11628 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11629 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11630 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11631 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11632 tcp-check send \r\n
11633 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11634 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11635
11636 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11637 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011638 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011639 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11640 tcp-check connect port 143
11641 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11642 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11643
11644 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11645
11646
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011647tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011648 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011649 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011650 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011651 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011652 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011653 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011654
11655 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011656 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11657
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011658 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11659 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11660 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11661 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11662 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11663 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11664 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11665 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11666 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11667 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11668
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011669 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011670 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11671 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011672 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11673 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11674 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11675
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011676 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11677 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11678 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011679 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11680 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011681 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11682 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011683 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11684 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011685 By default "L7OK" is used.
11686
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011687 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11688 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011689 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11690 supported :
11691 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11692 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011693 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11694 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11695 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11696 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11697 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011698
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011699 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011700 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011701 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11702 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11703 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11704 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011705 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11706
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011707 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11708 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11709 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11710 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11711
11712 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11713 informational message reported in logs if an error
11714 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11715 log-format string.
11716
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011717 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11718 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11719 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11720 followed by some converters.
11721
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011722 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11723 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11724 with the usual backslash ('\').
11725 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011726 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011727 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11728 used upper or lower case.
11729
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011730 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11731
11732 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11733 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11734 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11735 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11736 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11737 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11738 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11739 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11740
11741 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11742 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11743 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11744 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11745 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11746 expression.
11747
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011748 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11749 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11750 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11751 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11752 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11753 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11754
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011755 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11756 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11757 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11758 this exact hexadecimal string.
11759 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11760
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011761 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11762 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11763 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11764 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11765 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11766 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11767 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11768 size.
11769
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011770 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11771 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11772 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11773 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11774 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11775 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11776 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11777 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11778 in a binary string before matching the response's
11779 buffer.
11780
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011781 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011782 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011783 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11784 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11785 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11786 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11787 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11788 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11789 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11790 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11791 the null character.
11792
11793 Examples :
11794 # perform a POP check
11795 option tcp-check
11796 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11797
11798 # perform an IMAP check
11799 option tcp-check
11800 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11801
11802 # look for the redis master server
11803 option tcp-check
11804 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011805 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011806 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11807 tcp-check expect string role:master
11808 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11809 tcp-check expect string +OK
11810
11811
11812 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011813 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011814
11815
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011816tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11817tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11818 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11819 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011820 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011821 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011822
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011823 Arguments :
11824 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11825
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011826 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11827 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011828
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011829 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11830 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011831
11832 Examples :
11833 # look for the redis master server
11834 option tcp-check
11835 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11836 tcp-check expect string role:master
11837
11838 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011839 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011840
11841
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011842tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11843tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11844 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11845 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011846 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011847 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011848
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011849 Arguments :
11850 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011851
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011852 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11853 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011854
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011855 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11856 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11857 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011858
11859 Examples :
11860 # redis check in binary
11861 option tcp-check
11862 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11863 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11864
11865
11866 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011867 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011868
11869
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011870tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011871 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011872 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011873 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011874
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011875 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011876 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11877 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11878 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11879 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11880 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11881 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11882 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11883 and '-'.
11884
11885 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11886
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011887 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011888 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11889
11890
11891tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011892 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011893 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011894 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011895
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011896 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011897 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11898 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11899 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11900 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11901 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11902 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11903 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11904 and '-'.
11905
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011906 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011907 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11908
11909
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011910tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11911 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11913 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011914 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011915 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11916 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011917
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011918 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011919
11920 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11921 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011922 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11923 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11924 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11925 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11926 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11927 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011928
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011929 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11930 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11931 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11932 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011933
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011934 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011935 - accept :
11936 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11937 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11938 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011939
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011940 - reject :
11941 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11942 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11943 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11944 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11945 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11946 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11947 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11948 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11949 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11950 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11951 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011952 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011953
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011954 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11955 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11956 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11957 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11958 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11959 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11960 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11961 hosts.
11962
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011963 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11964 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11965 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11966 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11967 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11968 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11969 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11970 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11971
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011972 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11973 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11974 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11975 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11976 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11977 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11978 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11979 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11980 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011981 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11982 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011983
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011984 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011985 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011986 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11987 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11988 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011989 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011990 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011991 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11992 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11993 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11994 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11995 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11996 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11997 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011998
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011999 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012000 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012001 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012002 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012003 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
12004 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
12005 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012006
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012007 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
12008 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
12009 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
12010 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012011
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012012 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
12013 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
12014 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
12015 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
12016 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012017 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
12018 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
12019 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
12020 layer7 information is extracted.
12021
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012022 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
12023 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
12024 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
12025 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
12026 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012027
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012028 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>):
12029 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
12030 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
12031 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12032 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12033 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12034 no GPC stored at this index.
12035 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types
12036 (and not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate'
12037 data_types).
12038
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012039 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12040 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12041 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12042 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12043
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012044 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12045 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12046 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12047 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12048
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012049 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12050 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the
12051 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the
12052 value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
12053 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12054 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12055 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12056 no GPT stored at this index.
12057 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
12058 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
12059
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012060 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12061 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12062 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12063 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12064 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012065
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012066 - set-mark <mark>:
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +010012067 Is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the client
12068 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value
12069 is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by
12070 the routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace.
12071 It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
12072 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
12073 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works
12074 on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +010012075 on FreeBSD and OpenBSD.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012076
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012077 - set-src <expr> :
12078 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12079 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12080 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012081 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012082
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012083 Arguments:
12084 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12085 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012086
12087 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012088 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12089
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012090 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12091 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012092
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012093 - set-src-port <expr> :
12094 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12095 expression.
12096
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012097 Arguments:
12098 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12099 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012100
12101 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012102 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12103
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012104 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12105 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12106 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012107
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012108 - set-dst <expr> :
12109 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12110 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12111 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12112 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12113 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12114
12115 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12116 followed by some converters.
12117
12118 Example:
12119
12120 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12121 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12122
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012123 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12124 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12125
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012126 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12127 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12128 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12129 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12130
12131
12132 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12133 followed by some converters.
12134
12135 Example:
12136
12137 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12138
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012139 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12140 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12141 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12142
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012143 - set-tos <tos>:
12144 Is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12145 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
12146 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed
12147 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only
12148 the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
12149 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border
12150 routers based on some information from the request.
12151
12152 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
12153
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012154 - "silent-drop" :
12155 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012156 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012157 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12158 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12159 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12160 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12161 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012162 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12163 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012164 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12165 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012166 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012167 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12168 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12169 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12170 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12171
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012172 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12173 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12174 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012175
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012176 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12177 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12178 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012179
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012180 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012181 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012182 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012183
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012184 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12185 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12186 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012187
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012188 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012189 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12190 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012191
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012192 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12193
12194 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12195
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012196 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12197
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012198 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012199
12200
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012201tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12202 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012204 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012205 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012206 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12207 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012208
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012209 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012210
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012211 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012212 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12213 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012214 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12215 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012216
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012217 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12218 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12219 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12220 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012221 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012222 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012223 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12224 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12225 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12226 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012227 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012228 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012229
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012230 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12231 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12232 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12233 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012234
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012235 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012236 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012237 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012238 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12239 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012240 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012241 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012242 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012243 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012244 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012245 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012246 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012247 - set-dst <expr>
12248 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012249 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012250 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012251 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012252 - set-tos <tos>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012253 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012254 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012255 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012256 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012257 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012258 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012259
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012260 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12261 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012262 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12263 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012264
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012265 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12266 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12267 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12268 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12269 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12270 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012271
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012272 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012273 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12274 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012275
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012276 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12277 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12278 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12279 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12280 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12281 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12282
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012283 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012284 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12285 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12286 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12287 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12288 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12289 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12290 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12291 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12292 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12293 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012294
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012295 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012296 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12297 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12298 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012299
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012300 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12301 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12302
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012303 The "set-log-level" is used to set the log level of the current session. More
12304 information on how to use it at "http-request set-log-level".
12305
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012306 The "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK in all packets sent to the
12307 client. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-mark".
12308
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012309 The "set-nice" is used to set the "nice" factor of the current session. More
12310 information on how to use it at "http-request set-nice".
12311
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012312 The "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
12313 the client. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-tos".
12314
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012315 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012316 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12317 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012318
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012319 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12320 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012321 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012322 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12323 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012324 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012325 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012326 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012327 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12328 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012329 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012330 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12331 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012332
12333 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12334 followed by some converters.
12335
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012336 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012337 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12338 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12339 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12340 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12341 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12342 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012343 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012344 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12345 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12346
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012347 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12348
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012349 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12350 <var-name>.
12351
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012352 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12353 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12354 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12355 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12356 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12357
12358 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12359 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12360 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12361 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12362 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12363 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12364 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12365 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12366 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12367 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12368 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12369
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012370 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12371 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12372 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12373 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12374 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12375
12376 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12377
12378 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12379
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012380 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12381 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12382 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12383 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12384 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12385 evaluated.
12386
12387 Example:
12388 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12389
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012390 Example:
12391
12392 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012393 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012394
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012395 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012396 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012397 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012398 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12399 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012400 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012401 tcp-request content reject
12402
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012403 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12404 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12405 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12406 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12407 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12408 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12409 ...
12410 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12411
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012412 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012413 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12414 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12415 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012416 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012417
12418 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12419 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12420 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012421 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012422 tcp-request content reject
12423
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012424 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012425 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012426 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012427 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012428 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12429 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012430
12431 Example:
12432 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12433 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012434 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012435
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012436 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012437 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012438
12439 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012440 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012441 # protecting all our sites
12442 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012443 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12444 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012445 ...
12446 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12447
12448 backend http_dynamic
12449 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012450 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012451 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012452 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012453 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012454 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012455 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012456
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012457 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012458
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012459 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12460 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012461
12462
12463tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12464 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012466 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012467 Arguments :
12468 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12469 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12470 as explained at the top of this document.
12471
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012472 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012473 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12474 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12475 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12476 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12477
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012478 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12479 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12480 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12481 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12482
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012483 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012484 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012485 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012486 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012487 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012488 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12489 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12490 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012491
12492 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12493 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12494 it pass through unaffected.
12495
12496 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12497 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12498 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012499 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012500 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12501 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012502 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12503 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12504 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012505
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012506 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012507 "timeout client".
12508
12509
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012510tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12511 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12513 no | no | yes | yes
12514 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012515 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12516 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012517
12518 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12519
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012520 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012521 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12522 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012523 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12524 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012525
12526 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12527
12528 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12529 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12530 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12531 inserted.
12532
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012533 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012534 - accept :
12535 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12536 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12537 the rules evaluation.
12538
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012539 - close :
12540 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12541 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12542 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12543 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12544 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12545 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012546 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012547 protocols.
12548
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012549 - reject :
12550 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12551 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012552 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012553
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012554 - set-log-level <level>
12555 The "set-log-level" is used to set the log level of the current
12556 session. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12557 set-log-level".
12558
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012559 - set-mark <mark>
12560 The "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK in all packets sent to
12561 the client. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12562 set-mark".
12563
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012564 - set-nice <nice>
12565 The "set-nice" is used to set the "nice" factor of the current
12566 session. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12567 set-nice".
12568
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012569 - set-tos <tos>
12570 The "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets
12571 sent to the client. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12572 set-tos".
12573
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012574 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
12575 Sets a variable.
12576
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012577 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12578 Unsets a variable.
12579
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012580 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>):
12581 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
12582 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
12583 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12584 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12585 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12586 no GPC stored at this index.
12587 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types
12588 (and not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate'
12589 data_types).
12590
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012591 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12592 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12593 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12594 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12595
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012596 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12597 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12598 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12599 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12600
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012601 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12602 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the
12603 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the
12604 value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
12605 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12606 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12607 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12608 no GPT stored at this index.
12609 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
12610 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
12611
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012612 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12613 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12614 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12615 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12616 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012617
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012618 - "silent-drop" :
12619 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012620 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012621 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12622 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12623 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12624 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12625 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012626 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12627 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012628 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12629 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012630 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012631 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12632 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12633 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12634 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12635
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012636 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12637 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12638
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012639 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12640 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12641 for changing the default action to a reject.
12642
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012643 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12644 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12645 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12646 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012647 period.
12648
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012649 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12650 declared inline.
12651
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012652 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12653 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012654 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012655 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12656 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012657 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012658 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012659 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012660 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12661 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012662 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012663 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12664 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012665
12666 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12667 followed by some converters.
12668
12669 Example:
12670
12671 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
12672
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012673 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12674 <var-name>.
12675
12676 Example:
12677
12678 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
12679
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012680 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12681 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12682 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12683 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12684 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12685
12686 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12687
12688 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12689
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012690 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12691
12692 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12693
12694
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012695tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12696 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12698 no | yes | yes | no
12699 Arguments :
12700 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12701 below.
12702
12703 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12704
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012705 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012706 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12707 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12708 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12709 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12710 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12711 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12712 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012713 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012714 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12715 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12716 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12717 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12718 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12719 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12720 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12721 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12722 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12723 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12724 instead.
12725
12726 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12727 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12728 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12729 rules which may be inserted.
12730
12731 Several types of actions are supported :
12732 - accept : the request is accepted
12733 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12734 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012735 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012736 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012737 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012738 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012739 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012740 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet14aec6e2021-06-23 12:19:25 +020012741 - set-dst <expr>
12742 - set-dst-port <expr>
12743 - set-src <expr>
12744 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012745 - set-tos <tos>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012746 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012747 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012748 - silent-drop
12749
12750 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12751 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12752 sections for a complete description.
12753
12754 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12755 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12756 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12757
12758 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12759 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12760 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12761 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12762 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12763
12764 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12765 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12766
12767 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12768 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12769 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12770
12771 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12772 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12773 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12774
12775 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12776 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12777 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12778
12779 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12780 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12781 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12782
12783 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12784
12785 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12786
12787
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012788tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12789 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12791 no | no | yes | yes
12792 Arguments :
12793 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12794 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12795 as explained at the top of this document.
12796
12797 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12798
12799
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012800timeout check <timeout>
12801 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12802 established.
12803
12804 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12805 yes | no | yes | yes
12806 Arguments:
12807 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12808 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12809 as explained at the top of this document.
12810
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012811 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012812 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012813 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012814 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012815 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12816 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12817 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012818
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012819 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012820 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12821
12822 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12823 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012824 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012825
12826 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12827 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12828 forget about it.
12829
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012830 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12831 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012832
12833
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012834timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012835 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12837 yes | yes | yes | no
12838 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012839 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012840 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12841 as explained at the top of this document.
12842
12843 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12844 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12845 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012846 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12847 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12848 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12849 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012850 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12851 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12852 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012853 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012854 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012855 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12856 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012857 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12858 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012859
12860 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12861 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12862 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12863 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012864 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012865 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12866
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012867 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012868
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012869 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012870
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012871
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012872timeout client-fin <timeout>
12873 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12875 yes | yes | yes | no
12876 Arguments :
12877 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12878 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12879 as explained at the top of this document.
12880
12881 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12882 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12883 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12884 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12885 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12886 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12887 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012888 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12889 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12890 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012891
12892 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12893 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12894 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12895
12896 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12897
12898
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012899timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012900 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12902 yes | no | yes | yes
12903 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012904 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012905 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12906 as explained at the top of this document.
12907
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012908 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012909 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012910 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012911 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012912 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12913 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012914
12915 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12916 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12917 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12918 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012919 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012920 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12921
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012922 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012923
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012924
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012925timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12926 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12928 yes | yes | yes | yes
12929 Arguments :
12930 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12931 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12932 as explained at the top of this document.
12933
12934 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12935 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12936 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12937 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12938 once the request has started to present itself.
12939
12940 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12941 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12942 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12943 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12944 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12945
12946 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12947 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12948 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12949 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12950
12951 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12952 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012953 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012954 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12955 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012956 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012957
12958 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12959 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12960 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12961 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12962
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012963 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12964 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012965 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12966
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012967 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12968
12969
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012970timeout http-request <timeout>
12971 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012973 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012974 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012975 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012976 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12977 as explained at the top of this document.
12978
12979 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12980 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12981 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12982 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12983 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12984 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12985 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012986 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12987 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12988 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12989 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012990 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012991 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12992 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012993
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012994 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12995 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12996 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12997 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12998 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012999 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013000
13001 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
13002 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013003 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013004 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
13005 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
13006
13007 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013008 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
13009 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
13010 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013011
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013012 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013013 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013014
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013015
13016timeout queue <timeout>
13017 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13019 yes | no | yes | yes
13020 Arguments :
13021 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13022 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13023 as explained at the top of this document.
13024
13025 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13026 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13027 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13028 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13029 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13030
13031 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13032 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13033 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13034 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13035
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013036 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013037
13038
13039timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013040 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13042 yes | no | yes | yes
13043 Arguments :
13044 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13045 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13046 as explained at the top of this document.
13047
13048 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13049 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13050 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13051 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13052 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13053 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13054 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13055
13056 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13057 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13058 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13059 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13060 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013061 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013062 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013063 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13064 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013065 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13066 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013067
13068 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13069 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13070 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13071 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013072 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013073 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13074
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013075 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013076
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013077
13078timeout server-fin <timeout>
13079 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13081 yes | no | yes | yes
13082 Arguments :
13083 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13084 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13085 as explained at the top of this document.
13086
13087 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13088 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13089 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13090 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13091 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13092 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13093 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13094 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13095 situations, it should not be needed.
13096
13097 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13098 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13099 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13100
13101 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13102
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013103
13104timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013105 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13107 yes | yes | yes | yes
13108 Arguments :
13109 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13110 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13111 as explained at the top of this document.
13112
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013113 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13114 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13115 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013116
13117 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13118 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13119 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13120 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013121 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013122
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013123 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013124
13125
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013126timeout tunnel <timeout>
13127 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13129 yes | no | yes | yes
13130 Arguments :
13131 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13132 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13133 as explained at the top of this document.
13134
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013135 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013136 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13137 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13138 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013139 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13140 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013141 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13142 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13143 specified.
13144
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013145 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13146 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13147 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13148 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13149 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13150 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13151 state.
13152
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013153 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13154 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13155 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13156 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013157 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013158
13159 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13160 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13161 forget about it.
13162
13163 Example :
13164 defaults http
13165 option http-server-close
13166 timeout connect 5s
13167 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013168 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013169 timeout server 30s
13170 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13171
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013172 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013173
13174
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013175transparent (deprecated)
13176 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013178 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013179 Arguments : none
13180
13181 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13182 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13183 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13184 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13185 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13186 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13187 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13188 appropriate server.
13189
13190 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13191
13192 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13193 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13194
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013195 See also: "option transparent"
13196
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013197unique-id-format <string>
13198 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13200 yes | yes | yes | no
13201 Arguments :
13202 <string> is a log-format string.
13203
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013204 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13205 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13206 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13207 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013208
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013209 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013210 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013211 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13212 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13213 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13214 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13215 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13216 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013217
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013218 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13219 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013220
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013221 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013222
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013223 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013224
13225 will generate:
13226
13227 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13228
13229 See also: "unique-id-header"
13230
13231unique-id-header <name>
13232 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13234 yes | yes | yes | no
13235 Arguments :
13236 <name> is the name of the header.
13237
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013238 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13239 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013240
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013241 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013242
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013243 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013244 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13245
13246 will generate:
13247
13248 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13249
13250 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013251
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013252use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013253 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13255 no | yes | yes | no
13256 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013257 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13258 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013259
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013260 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13261 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013262
13263 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13264 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13265 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013266 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013267 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013268 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13269 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013270
13271 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13272 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13273 assign the backend.
13274
13275 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13276 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13277 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13278 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13279 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13280 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13281
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013282 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013283 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013284 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13285 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13286 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13287
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013288 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13289 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13290 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13291 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13292 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13293 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13294 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13295 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13296 cannot be forced from the request.
13297
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013298 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013299 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13300 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13301
13302 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13303 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013304
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013305use-fcgi-app <name>
13306 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13308 no | no | yes | yes
13309 Arguments :
13310 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13311
13312 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013313
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013314use-server <server> if <condition>
13315use-server <server> unless <condition>
13316 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13318 no | no | yes | yes
13319 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013320 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13321 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013322
13323 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13324
13325 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13326 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13327 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13328
13329 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13330 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13331 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13332 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13333 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13334 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13335 matches will assign the server.
13336
13337 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13338 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13339 with the next rules until one matches.
13340
13341 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13342 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13343 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13344 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13345
13346 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13347 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13348 stripped.
13349
13350 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13351 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013352 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013353 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013354 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013355
13356 Example :
13357 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013358 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013359 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013360 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013361 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013362 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013363 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013364 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13365 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13366
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013367 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13368 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13369 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13370 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013371 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013372 and we fall back to load balancing.
13373
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013374 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013375
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013376
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133775. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013378--------------------------
13379
13380The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13381depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13382settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13383written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13384described in this section.
13385
13386
133875.1. Bind options
13388-----------------
13389
13390The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13391as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13392no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13393parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13394while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13395provided immediately after the setting name.
13396
13397The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13398
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013399accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13400 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13401 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13402 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13403 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13404 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13405 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13406 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13407 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13408 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013409 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13410 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13411 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013412
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013413accept-proxy
13414 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013415 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13416 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013417 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13418 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13419 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13420 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013421 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013422 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13423 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013424 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13425 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013426
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013427allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013428 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013429 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013430 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013431 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13432 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013433
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013434alpn <protocols>
13435 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13436 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13437 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013438 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013439 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013440 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13441 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13442 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13443 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13444 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13445 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13446 preference, like below :
13447
13448 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013449
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013450backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013451 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013452 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13453
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013454curves <curves>
13455 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13456 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13457 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13458 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13459 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13460 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13461
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013462ecdhe <named curve>
13463 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013464 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13465 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013466
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013467ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013468 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13469 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13470 client's certificate.
13471
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013472ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13473 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13474 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13475 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13476 error is ignored.
13477
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013478ca-sign-file <cafile>
13479 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13480 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13481 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13482 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13483 'generate-certificates' for details.
13484
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013485ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013486 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13487 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13488 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13489 'generate-certificates' for details.
13490
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013491ca-verify-file <cafile>
13492 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13493 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13494 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13495 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13496 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13497
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013498ciphers <ciphers>
13499 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13500 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013501 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013502 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013503 information and recommendations see e.g.
13504 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13505 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13506 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13507
13508ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13509 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13510 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13511 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13512 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013513 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13514 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013515
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013516crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013517 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13518 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013519 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13520 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013521
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013522crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013523 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13524 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13525 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13526 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13527 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013528 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13529 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013530
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013531 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13532 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13533
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013534 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13535 are loaded.
13536
13537 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013538 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13539 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13540 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13541 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13542 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13543 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13544 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013545 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013546
13547 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13548 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13549 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13550 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013551 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13552 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013553
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013554 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013555
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013556 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013557 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013558 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13559 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013560 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13561 clients).
13562
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013563 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013564 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13565 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13566 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13567 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13568 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13569 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13570 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13571 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13572 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13573 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13574 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13575 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13576
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013577 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013578 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13579 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13580 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13581 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13582
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013583 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13584 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13585 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13586 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013587
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013588 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13589 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13590 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013591
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013592crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013593 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013594 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013595 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013596 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013597
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013598crt-list <file>
13599 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013600 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13601 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013602
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013603 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13604
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013605 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13606 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13607 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13608 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13609 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013610
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013611 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013612 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13613 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13614 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13615 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13616 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013617 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13618 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13619 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013620
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013621 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13622 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13623 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013624
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013625 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13626
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013627 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013628 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013629 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13630 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13631 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13632 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13633 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13634 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013635
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013636 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013637 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013638 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013639 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013640 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013641 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013642
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013643defer-accept
13644 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13645 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13646 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013647 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013648 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13649 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13650 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13651 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13652 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13653 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13654 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13655
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013656expose-fd listeners
13657 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13658 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013659 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13660 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013661 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013662
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013663force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013664 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013665 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013666 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013667 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013668
13669force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013670 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013671 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013672 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013673
13674force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013675 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013676 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013677 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013678
13679force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013680 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013681 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013682 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013683
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013684force-tlsv13
13685 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13686 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013687 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013688
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013689generate-certificates
13690 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13691 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13692 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13693 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13694 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13695 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13696 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13697 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13698 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13699 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13700 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13701
13702 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13703 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013704 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013705 certificate is used many times.
13706
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013707gid <gid>
13708 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13709 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13710 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13711 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13712 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13713
13714group <group>
13715 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13716 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13717 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13718 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13719 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13720
13721id <id>
13722 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13723 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13724 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13725 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13726
13727interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013728 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13729 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13730 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13731 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13732 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13733 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013734 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13735 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13736 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13737 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13738 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13739 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013740
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013741level <level>
13742 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13743 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13744 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013745 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013746 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13747 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13748 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013749 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013750 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013751 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013752 all counters).
13753
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013754severity-output <format>
13755 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13756 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13757 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13758 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13759 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13760 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13761 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13762 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13763 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13764 rfc5424 convention.
13765
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013766maxconn <maxconn>
13767 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13768 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13769 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13770 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13771 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13772 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13773 eat all memory.
13774
13775mode <mode>
13776 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13777 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13778 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13779 UNIX sockets.
13780
13781mss <maxseg>
13782 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13783 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13784 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13785 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13786 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13787 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13788 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13789 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13790 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13791 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13792 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13793
13794name <name>
13795 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13796 page.
13797
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013798namespace <name>
13799 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13800 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13801 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13802 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13803
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013804nice <nice>
13805 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13806 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13807 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13808 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13809 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13810 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13811 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13812 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13813 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13814 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13815 one for an RDP socket.
13816
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013817no-ca-names
13818 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13819 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013820 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013821
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013822no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013823 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013824 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013825 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013826 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013827 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13828 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013829
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013830no-tls-tickets
13831 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13832 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13833 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013834 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13835 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013836 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13837 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13838 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013839
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013840no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013841 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013842 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013843 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013844 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013845 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13846 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013847
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013848no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013849 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013850 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013851 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013852 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013853 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13854 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013855
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013856no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013857 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013858 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013859 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013860 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013861 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13862 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013863
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013864no-tlsv13
13865 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13866 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13867 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13868 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013869 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13870 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013871
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013872npn <protocols>
13873 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13874 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13875 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013876 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013877 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013878 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13879 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13880 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13881 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13882 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013883
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013884prefer-client-ciphers
13885 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13886 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13887 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013888 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13889 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13890 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013891
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013892process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020013893 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
13894 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. Note
13895 that only process number 1 is permitted. If a thread set is specified, it
13896 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
13897 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
13898 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013899
13900 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13901
13902 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020013903 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
13904 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
13905 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
13906 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
13907 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013908
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013909proto <name>
13910 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13911 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13912 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013913 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13914 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13915
13916 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13917 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13918 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13919 also reported (flag=HTX).
13920
13921 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13922 a bind line :
13923
13924 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13925 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13926 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13927
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013928 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013929 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013930 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013931 h2" on the bind line.
13932
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013933ssl
13934 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013935 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013936 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13937 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013938 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13939 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013940
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013941ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13942 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013943 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13944 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13945 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013946 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13947
13948ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013949 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13950 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13951 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13952 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013953
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013954strict-sni
13955 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13956 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13957 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13958 See the "crt" option for more information.
13959
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013960tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013961 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013962 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013963 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013964 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013965 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13966 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13967 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13968 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13969 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13970 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13971 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13972
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013973tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013974 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013975 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13976 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13977 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13978 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13979 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13980 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13981 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013982 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13983 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13984 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013985
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013986tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13987 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013988 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13989 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13990 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13991 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13992 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13993 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13994 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13995 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13996 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13997 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013998 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13999 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
14000
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014001transparent
14002 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14003 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
14004 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
14005 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
14006 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14007 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14008 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14009 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14010 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14011 so check for support with your vendor.
14012
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014013v4v6
14014 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14015 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14016 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14017 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014018 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014019
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014020v6only
14021 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14022 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14023 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014024 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14025 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014026
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014027uid <uid>
14028 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14029 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14030 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14031 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14032 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14033
14034user <user>
14035 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14036 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14037 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14038 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14039 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14040
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014041verify [none|optional|required]
14042 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14043 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14044 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14045 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14046 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014047 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14048 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14049 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14050 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014051
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200140525.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014053------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014054
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014055The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14056which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14057arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14058settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14059after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14060Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14061address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014062
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014063 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014064 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014065
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014066Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14067keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14068
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014069The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014070
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014071addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014072 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014073 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14074 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14075 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14076 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14077 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014078
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014079agent-check
14080 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014081 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014082 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14083 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14084 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014085
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014086 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014087 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014088 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014089 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14090 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014091
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014092 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14093 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14094 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14095 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14096 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014097
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014098 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014099 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014100
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014101 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14102 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14103 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014104
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014105 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14106 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14107 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014108
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014109 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014110 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14111 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14112 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14113 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014114 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014115 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014116
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014117 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14118 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014119
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014120 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14121 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14122 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14123 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14124 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14125 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14126 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14127 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14128 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014129
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014130 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14131 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014132 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14133 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14134 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014135 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014136
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014137 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014138 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014139
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014140agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014141 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014142 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14143 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14144 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14145 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14146
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014147agent-inter <delay>
14148 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14149 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14150
14151 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14152 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14153 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14154 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14155 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14156 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14157 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14158 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14159 of backends use the same servers.
14160
14161 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14162
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014163agent-addr <addr>
14164 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14165
14166 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014167 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014168 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14169 hostname, it will be resolved.
14170
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014171agent-port <port>
14172 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14173
14174 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14175
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014176allow-0rtt
14177 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014178 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14179 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014180
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014181alpn <protocols>
14182 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14183 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14184 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014185 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014186 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14187 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14188 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14189 now obsolete NPN extension.
14190 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14191 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14192
14193 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14194
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014195backup
14196 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14197 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14198 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14199 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014200 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14201 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014202
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014203ca-file <cafile>
14204 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14205 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14206 server's certificate.
14207
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014208check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014209 This option enables health checks on a server:
14210 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14211 considered available.
14212 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14213 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14214 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14215 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14216 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14217 set.
14218 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14219 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14220 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14221 exchanges succeed.
14222
14223 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14224 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14225 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14226 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14227 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014228 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014229 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14230
14231 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14232 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14233
14234 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14235 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14236
14237 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14238 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14239 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14240 available.
14241
14242 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14243 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14244 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14245
14246 Example:
14247 # simple tcp check
14248 backend foo
14249 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14250 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14251 backend foo
14252 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14253 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14254 backend foo
14255 option tcp-check
14256 tcp-check connect
14257 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014258
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014259check-send-proxy
14260 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14261 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14262 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14263 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14264 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14265 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14266 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14267
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014268check-alpn <protocols>
14269 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14270 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14271 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14272
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014273check-proto <name>
14274 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14275 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14276 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014277 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14278 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14279
14280 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14281 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14282 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14283 also reported (flag=HTX).
14284
14285 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14286 directive on a server line:
14287
14288 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14289 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14290 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14291 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14292
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014293 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014294 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14295 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14296
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014297check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014298 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014299 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14300 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014301
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014302check-ssl
14303 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14304 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14305 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14306 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014307 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014308 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14309 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014310 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014311 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14312 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014313
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014314check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014315 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014316 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14317 for normal traffic.
14318
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014319ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014320 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14321 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14322 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014323 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14324 information and recommendations see e.g.
14325 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14326 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14327 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014328
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014329ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14330 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14331 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14332 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14333 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014334 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14335 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14336 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014337
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014338cookie <value>
14339 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14340 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14341 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14342 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14343 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14344 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14345 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14346
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014347crl-file <crlfile>
14348 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14349 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14350 to verify server's certificate.
14351
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014352crt <cert>
14353 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14354 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14355 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14356 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14357 certificate request.
14358
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014359 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14360 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14361 option is set accordingly).
14362
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014363disabled
14364 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14365 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14366 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14367 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14368 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014369 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014370
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014371enabled
14372 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14373 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14374 default value.
14375 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14376 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014377
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014378error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014379 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14380 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14381 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014382
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014383 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014384
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014385fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014386 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14387 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14388 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14389
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014390force-sslv3
14391 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14392 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014393 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014394 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014395
14396force-tlsv10
14397 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014398 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014399 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014400
14401force-tlsv11
14402 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014403 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014404 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014405
14406force-tlsv12
14407 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014408 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014409 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014410
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014411force-tlsv13
14412 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14413 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014414 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014415
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014416id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014417 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14418 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14419 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014420
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014421init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14422 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14423 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014424 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014425 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14426 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14427 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14428 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14429 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14430 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14431 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14432 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14433 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014434 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014435 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14436 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14437 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14438 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14439 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14440 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014441 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014442
14443 Example:
14444 defaults
14445 # never fail on address resolution
14446 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14447
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014448inter <delay>
14449fastinter <delay>
14450downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014451 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14452 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14453 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14454 between checks depending on the server state :
14455
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014456 Server state | Interval used
14457 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14458 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14459 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14460 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14461 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14462 or yet unchecked. |
14463 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14464 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14465 | "inter" otherwise.
14466 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014467
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014468 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14469 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14470 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14471 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014472 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14473 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14474 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14475 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14476 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014477
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014478log-proto <logproto>
14479 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14480 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14481 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14482 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14483
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014484maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014485 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14486 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014487 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14488 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014489 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14490 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14491 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14492 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14493
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014494 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14495 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14496 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14497 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14498 than 50 concurrent requests.
14499
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014500maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014501 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14502 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14503 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14504 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014505 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14506 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14507 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14508 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14509 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14510 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14511 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014512
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014513max-reuse <count>
14514 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14515 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14516 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14517 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14518 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14519 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14520 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14521 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14522
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014523minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014524 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14525 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14526 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14527 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14528 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14529 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014530 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014531 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014532
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014533namespace <name>
14534 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14535 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14536 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14537 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14538
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014539no-agent-check
14540 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14541 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14542 default value.
14543 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14544 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14545
14546no-backup
14547 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14548 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14549 default value.
14550 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14551 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14552
14553no-check
14554 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14555 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14556 default value.
14557 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14558 "default-server" "check" setting.
14559
14560no-check-ssl
14561 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14562 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14563 default value.
14564 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14565 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14566
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014567no-send-proxy
14568 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14569 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14570 default value.
14571 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14572 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14573
14574no-send-proxy-v2
14575 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14576 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14577 default value.
14578 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14579 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14580
14581no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14582 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14583 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14584 default value.
14585 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14586 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14587
14588no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14589 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14590 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14591 default value.
14592 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14593 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14594
14595no-ssl
14596 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14597 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14598 default value.
14599 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14600 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14601
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014602 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14603 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14604 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14605
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014606no-ssl-reuse
14607 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14608 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14609 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14610 and for paranoid users.
14611
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014612no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014613 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14614 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014615 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014616
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014617 Supported in default-server: No
14618
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014619no-tls-tickets
14620 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14621 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14622 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014623 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14624 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014625 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14626 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14627 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014628 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014629
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014630no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014631 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014632 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14633 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014634 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14635 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014636 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014637
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014638 Supported in default-server: No
14639
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014640no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014641 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014642 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14643 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014644 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14645 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014646 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014647
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014648 Supported in default-server: No
14649
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014650no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014651 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014652 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14653 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014654 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14655 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014656 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014657
14658 Supported in default-server: No
14659
14660no-tlsv13
14661 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14662 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14663 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14664 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14665 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014666 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014667
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014668 Supported in default-server: No
14669
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014670no-verifyhost
14671 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14672 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14673 default value.
14674 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14675 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014676
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014677no-tfo
14678 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14679 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14680 default value.
14681 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14682 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14683
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014684non-stick
14685 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14686 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14687 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14688
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014689npn <protocols>
14690 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14691 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14692 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014693 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014694 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14695 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14696 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14697
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014698observe <mode>
14699 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14700 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14701 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14702 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14703 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14704 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014705 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014706
14707 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14708
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014709on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014710 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14711 Currently, four modes are available:
14712 - fastinter: force fastinter
14713 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14714 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14715 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14716 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14717
14718 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14719
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014720on-marked-down <action>
14721 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14722 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014723 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14724 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14725 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14726 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14727 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14728 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14729 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14730 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014731
14732 Actions are disabled by default
14733
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014734on-marked-up <action>
14735 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14736 Currently one action is available:
14737 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14738 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14739 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14740 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014741 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14742 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014743 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14744 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14745
14746 Actions are disabled by default
14747
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014748pool-low-conn <max>
14749 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14750 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14751 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14752 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14753 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14754 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14755 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14756 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14757 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14758 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014759 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14760 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14761 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14762 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014763
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014764pool-max-conn <max>
14765 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14766 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14767 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14768 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14769 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14770 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14771
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014772pool-purge-delay <delay>
14773 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014774 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014775 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014776
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014777port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014778 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014779 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14780 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14781 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14782 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14783 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014784
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014785proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014786 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14787 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14788 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014789 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14790 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14791
14792 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14793 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14794 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14795 also reported (flag=HTX).
14796
14797 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14798 a server line :
14799
14800 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14801 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14802 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14803 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14804
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014805 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014806 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14807
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014808redir <prefix>
14809 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14810 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14811 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14812 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14813 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14814 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14815 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14816 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014817 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014818 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014819 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14820 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14821 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14822 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14823
14824 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14825
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014826rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014827 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14828 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14829 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14830
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014831resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14832 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14833 server.
14834
14835 Available options:
14836
14837 * allow-dup-ip
14838 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14839 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14840 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14841 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14842 For such case, simply enable this option.
14843 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14844
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014845 * ignore-weight
14846 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14847 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14848 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14849
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014850 * prevent-dup-ip
14851 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14852 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14853 same fqdn.
14854 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14855
14856 Example:
14857 backend b_myapp
14858 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14859 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14860 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14861
14862 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14863 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14864 it
14865 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14866 different address
14867
14868 Default value: not set
14869
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014870resolve-prefer <family>
14871 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14872 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14873 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14874 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14875
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014876 Default value: ipv6
14877
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014878 Example:
14879
14880 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014881
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014882resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014883 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014884 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014885 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014886 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14887 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014888 configured network, another address is selected.
14889
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014890 Example:
14891
14892 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014893
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014894resolvers <id>
14895 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14896 hostname.
14897
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014898 Example:
14899
14900 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014901
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014902 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014903
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014904send-proxy
14905 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14906 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14907 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14908 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014909 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14910 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14911 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14912 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014913 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014914 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14915 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14916 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14917 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14918 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014919 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14920 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014921
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014922send-proxy-v2
14923 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14924 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14925 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14926 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014927 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14928 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14929 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14930 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014931
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014932proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014933 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14934 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14935
14936 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14937 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14938 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14939 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14940 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14941 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14942 connection is supported).
14943 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14944 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14945 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14946 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14947 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14948 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14949 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014950
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014951send-proxy-v2-ssl
14952 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14953 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14954 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14955 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14956 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14957 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14958 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014959 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14960 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014961
14962send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14963 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14964 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14965 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14966 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14967 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14968 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14969 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14970 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014971 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14972 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014973
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014974slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014975 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14976 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14977 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14978 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14979 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14980 parameters :
14981
14982 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14983 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14984
14985 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14986 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14987 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14988 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14989
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014990 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014991 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14992 seen as failed.
14993
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014994sni <expression>
14995 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14996 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14997 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14998 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014999 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
15000 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015001 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010015002 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15003 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015004
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015005source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015006source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015007source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015008 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15009 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15010 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15011 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15012
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015013 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15014 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15015 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15016 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15017 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15018 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15019 server.
15020
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015021 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15022 specifying the source address without port(s).
15023
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015024ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015025 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15026 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15027 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15028 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15029 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15030 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015031 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15032 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015033
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015034ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15035 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15036 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15037 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15038
15039ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15040 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15041 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15042 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15043
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015044ssl-reuse
15045 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15046 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15047 default value.
15048 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15049 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15050
15051stick
15052 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15053 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15054 default value.
15055 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15056 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015057
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015058socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015059 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015060 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15061 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15062
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015063tcp-ut <delay>
15064 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015065 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015066 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015067 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015068 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15069 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15070 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15071 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15072 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15073 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15074 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15075 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15076 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15077
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015078tfo
15079 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15080 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15081 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15082 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015083 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015084 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015085
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015086track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015087 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15088 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15089 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15090 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015091 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15092
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015093tls-tickets
15094 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15095 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15096 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015097 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15098 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15099 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015100 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015101 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015102
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015103verify [none|required]
15104 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015105 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015106 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15107 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015108 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015109 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15110 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15111 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15112 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15113 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15114 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15115 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15116 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015117
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015118verifyhost <hostname>
15119 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015120 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15121 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15122 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15123 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15124 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15125 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15126 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15127 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015128
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015129weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015130 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15131 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15132 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015133 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15134 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15135 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15136 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15137 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15138 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015139
15140
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151415.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15142-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015143
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015144HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15145using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015146configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015147This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15148can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15149workload.
15150This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15151resolution at run time.
15152Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15153carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15154
15155
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151565.3.1. Global overview
15157----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015158
15159As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15160different steps of the process life:
15161
15162 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15163 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15164 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15165
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015166 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15167 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015168
15169A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15170 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15171 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15172 resolution to know this new IP.
15173
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015174When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015175HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015176SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15177from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015178will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015179will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015180
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015181A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015182 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015183 first valid response.
15184
15185 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15186 servers return an error.
15187
15188
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151895.3.2. The resolvers section
15190----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015191
15192This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015193HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15194contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015195
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015196When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15197uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15198is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15199answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15200
15201When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015202used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015203
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015204 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15205 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15206 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015207
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015208 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15209 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015210
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015211 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
15212 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15213 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015214
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015215For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15216following scenarios are possible:
15217
15218 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15219 ignored
15220
15221 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15222 applied
15223
15224 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15225 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15226
15227 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15228 retries the query with a new type
15229
15230 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15231 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015232
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015233As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015234a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015235<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015236
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015237
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015238resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015239 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015240
15241A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15242
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015243accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015244 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015245 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015246 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15247 by RFC 6891)
15248
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015249 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15250 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15251 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15252 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15253 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15254 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015255
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015256nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15257 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15258 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15259 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15260 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15261 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15262 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15263 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15264 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15265 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015266 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15267
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015268parse-resolv-conf
15269 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15270 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15271 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15272
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015273hold <status> <period>
15274 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15275 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015276 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015277 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015278 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15279 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15280 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15281
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015282 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015283
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015284resolve_retries <nb>
15285 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15286 giving up.
15287 Default value: 3
15288
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015289 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15290 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15291 type.
15292
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015293timeout <event> <time>
15294 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15295 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15296 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015297 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15298 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015299 Default value: 1s
15300 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015301 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015302 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015303 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15304 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15305
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015306 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015307
15308 resolvers mydns
15309 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15310 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015311 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015312 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015313 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015314 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015315 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015316 hold other 30s
15317 hold refused 30s
15318 hold nx 30s
15319 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015320 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015321 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015322
15323
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200153246. Cache
15325---------
15326
15327HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15328(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15329RAM.
15330
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020015331The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
15332blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015333
15334If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15335independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15336when we try to allocate a new one.
15337
15338The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15339
15340It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15341"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15342for more details.
15343
15344When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15345replaced by "<CACHE>".
15346
15347
153486.1. Limitation
15349----------------
15350
15351The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15352
15353- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015354- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15355 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15356 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015357- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15358- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015359- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15360 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15361 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015362- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15363 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015364- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15365 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15366 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015367
15368- If the request is not a GET
15369- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15370- If the request contains an Authorization header
15371
15372
153736.2. Setup
15374-----------
15375
15376To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15377the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15378
15379
153806.2.1. Cache section
15381---------------------
15382
15383cache <name>
15384 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15385 size of cache is mandatory.
15386
15387total-max-size <megabytes>
15388 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15389 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15390
15391max-object-size <bytes>
15392 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15393 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15394 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15395
15396max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015397 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015398 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15399 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15400 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15401 default.
15402
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015403process-vary <on/off>
15404 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015405 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15406 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15407 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015408 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015409
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015410max-secondary-entries <number>
15411 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15412 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15413 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15414
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015415
154166.2.2. Proxy section
15417---------------------
15418
15419http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15420 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15421 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15422 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15423 after this one.
15424
15425http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15426 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15427 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15428 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15429 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15430
15431
15432Example:
15433
15434 backend bck1
15435 mode http
15436
15437 http-request cache-use foobar
15438 http-response cache-store foobar
15439 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15440
15441 cache foobar
15442 total-max-size 4
15443 max-age 240
15444
15445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154467. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15447----------------------------------
15448
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015449HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015450client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15451The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15452these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15453but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15454data called patterns.
15455
15456
154577.1. ACL basics
15458---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015459
15460The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15461content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15462from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15463simple :
15464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015465 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015466 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015467 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15468 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015470The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15471adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015472
15473In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015475 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015476
15477This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15478Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15479and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015480an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15481conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15482as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15483are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015484
15485ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15486'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15487which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15488
15489There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15490performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015492The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15493specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15494this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015495methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15496ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015497
15498Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15499 - boolean
15500 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15501 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15502 - string
15503 - data block
15504
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015505Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15506converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15507would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15508The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15509which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15510
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015511Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15512keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15513fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15514which are summarized in the table below :
15515
15516 +---------------------+-----------------+
15517 | Sample or converter | Default |
15518 | output type | matching method |
15519 +---------------------+-----------------+
15520 | boolean | bool |
15521 +---------------------+-----------------+
15522 | integer | int |
15523 +---------------------+-----------------+
15524 | ip | ip |
15525 +---------------------+-----------------+
15526 | string | str |
15527 +---------------------+-----------------+
15528 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15529 +---------------------+-----------------+
15530
15531Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15532matching method, see below.
15533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015534The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15535 - boolean
15536 - integer or integer range
15537 - IP address / network
15538 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15539 - regular expression
15540 - hex block
15541
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015542The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15543
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015544 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15545 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015546 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015547 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015548 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015549 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015550 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015552The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15553read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15554if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15555lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15556will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15557beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015558a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015559lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15560exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15561
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015562The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15563parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15564ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15565a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15566check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15567
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015568The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15569socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15570file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015572Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15573loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15574
15575 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15576
15577In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15578the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15579case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15580as well.
15581
15582The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15583sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15584do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15585methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15586is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015587obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015588followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15589default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15590that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15591string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15592
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015593The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15594By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15595string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15596resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015597server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015598waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015599flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15600function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015602There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15603sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15604be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015605
15606 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15607 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015608 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15609 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15610 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15611 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015612
15613 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15614 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015615 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015616
15617 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015618 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015619
15620 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015621 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015622
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015623 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015624 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15625
15626 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15627 binary or string samples.
15628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015629 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15630 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015632 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15633 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15634 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015636 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15637 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015639 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15640 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015642 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15643 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015645 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15646 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015647 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015649 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15650 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15651 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015652
15653For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15654request, it is possible to do :
15655
15656 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15657
15658In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15659buffer, one would use the following acl :
15660
15661 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15662
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015663On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15664possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15665
15666 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015668All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15669criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15670method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15671to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15672criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15673the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015675If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015676the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15677For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015679 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15680 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15681 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15682 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015683
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015684
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015685The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15686types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15687combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15688brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15689default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015691 +-------------------------------------------------+
15692 | Input sample type |
15693 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015694 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015695 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15696 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15697 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015698 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015699 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015700 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015701 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015702 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015703 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015704 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015705 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015706 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015707 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015708 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015709 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015710 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015711 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015712 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015713 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015714 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015715 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015716 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015717 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015718 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015719 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15720 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15721 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015722
15723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157247.1.1. Matching booleans
15725------------------------
15726
15727In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15728Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15729When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15730that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15731
15732Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15733return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15734"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15735
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157377.1.2. Matching integers
15738------------------------
15739
15740Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15741enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15742to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15743
15744Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15745matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15746lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015747
15748For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15749unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15750representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15751
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015752As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15753two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15754instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15755ranges and operators.
15756
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015757For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015758operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15759Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15760of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015761
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015762Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015763
15764 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15765 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15766 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15767 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15768 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15769
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015770For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015771
15772 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15773
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015774This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15775
15776 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15777
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157797.1.3. Matching strings
15780-----------------------
15781
15782String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15783different forms :
15784
15785 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015786 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015787
15788 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015789 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015790
15791 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15792 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15793
15794 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15795 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15796
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015797 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015798 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15799 matches.
15800
15801 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15802 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15803 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015804
15805String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15806exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15807characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15808string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15809to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015810before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015811
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015812Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15813(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15814Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15815
15816Example:
15817 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15818 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15819
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158217.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15822---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015823
15824Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15825they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15826possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15827passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15828the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015829the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15830match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015831
15832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158337.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15834-------------------------------------
15835
15836It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15837not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15838a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15839to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15840digits may be used upper or lower case.
15841
15842Example :
15843 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15844 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15845
15846
158477.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15848---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015849
15850IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15851netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15852within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015853host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015854difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15855at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15856does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15857parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015858
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015859The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15860abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15861
15862 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15863 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15864 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15865 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15866 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15867 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15868 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15869 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15870
15871Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15872192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15873
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015874IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15875Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15876trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15877IPv6 patterns.
15878
15879HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15880following situations :
15881 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15882 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15883 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15884 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15885 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15886 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15887 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15888 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15889 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15890 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015892
158937.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15894----------------------------------
15895
15896Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15897combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15898
15899 - AND (implicit)
15900 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15901 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015903A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015905 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015907Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15908indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015910For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15911"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15912requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15913is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15914
15915 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015916 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15917 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15918 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015919
15920To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15921and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15922
15923 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15924 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15925 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15926 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15927
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015928 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015929 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15930 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15931 use_backend www if host_www
15932
15933It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15934expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15935be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15936the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15937
15938 The following rule :
15939
15940 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015941 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015942
15943 Can also be written that way :
15944
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015945 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015946
15947It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15948to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15949simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15950sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15951good use is the following :
15952
15953 With named ACLs :
15954
15955 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15956 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15957 monitor fail if site_dead
15958
15959 With anonymous ACLs :
15960
15961 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15962
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015963See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15964keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015965
15966
159677.3. Fetching samples
15968---------------------
15969
15970Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15971against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15972sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15973ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15974of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15975available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15976
15977This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15978Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15979compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15980deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15981
15982The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15983matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15984method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15985indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15986
15987As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15988when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15989mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15990the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15991ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15992
15993Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15994multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15995when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015996incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15997are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015998is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15999all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16000
16001Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16002 - name
16003 - name(arg1)
16004 - name(arg1,arg2)
16005
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016006
160077.3.1. Converters
16008-----------------
16009
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016010Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16011of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16012is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16013was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016014has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016015unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16016
16017These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16018sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16019the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016020support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016021
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016022A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16023support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16024supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16025(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16026bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016028The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016029
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001603051d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16031 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16032 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16033 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16034 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16035 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16036
16037 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016038 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16039 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016040 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16041 frontend http-in
16042 bind *:8081
16043 default_backend servers
16044 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16045 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16046
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016047add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016048 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016049 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016050 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16051 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016052 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016053 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16054 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16055 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16056 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016057 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016058 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016059
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016060aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16061 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16062 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16063 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16064 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16065 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16066 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16067
16068 Example:
16069 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16070 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16071
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016072and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016073 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016074 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016075 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16076 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016077 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016078 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16079 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16080 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16081 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016082 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016083 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016084
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016085b64dec
16086 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16087 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016088 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16089 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016090
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016091base64
16092 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016093 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016094 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16095 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016096
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020016097be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
16098 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
16099 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
16100 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
16101 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
16102 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
16103
16104 Example:
16105 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
16106 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
16107 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
16108 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
16109
Marcin Deranekda0264a2021-07-13 14:08:56 +020016110be2hex([<separator>],[<chunk_size>],[<truncate>])
16111 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex
16112 digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some
16113 binary input data in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID
16114 can be copied in a header). <separator> is put every <chunk_size> binary
16115 input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates whatever binary input is
16116 truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries.
16117
16118 Example:
16119 bin(01020304050607),be2hex # 01020304050607
16120 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(:,2) # 0102:0304:0506:07
16121 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(--,2,1) # 0102--0304--0506
16122 bin(0102030405060708),be2hex(,3,1) # 010203040506
16123
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016124bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016125 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016126 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016127 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016128 presence of a flag).
16129
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016130bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16131 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16132 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016133 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016134
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016135concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16136 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16137 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16138 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16139 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16140 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16141 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16142 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16143 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16144 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16145 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016146 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016147 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016148 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16149 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016150
16151 Example:
16152 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16153 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16154 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016155 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016156 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16157
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016158cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016159 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16160 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016161
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016162crc32([<avalanche>])
16163 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16164 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16165 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16166 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16167 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16168 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16169 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16170 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16171 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16172 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016173 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16174
16175crc32c([<avalanche>])
16176 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16177 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16178 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16179 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16180 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16181 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16182 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16183 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016184
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016185cut_crlf
16186 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16187 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16188 updated.
16189
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016190da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016191 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16192 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16193 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16194 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016195 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016196 configuration language.
16197
16198 Example:
16199 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016200 bind *:8881
16201 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016202 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016203
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016204debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16205 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16206 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16207 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16208 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16209 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16210 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16211 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16212 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16213 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16214 printable sample types.
16215
16216 Example:
16217 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016218
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016219digest(<algorithm>)
16220 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16221 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16222
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016223 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016224 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16225
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016226div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016227 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16228 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016229 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016230 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16231 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016232 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016233 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16234 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16235 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16236 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016237 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016238 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016239
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016240djb2([<avalanche>])
16241 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16242 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16243 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16244 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16245 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16246 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16247 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016248 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16249 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016250
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016251even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016252 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016253 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16254
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016255field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16256 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16257 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16258 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16259 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16260 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16261 fields.
16262
16263 Example :
16264 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16265 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16266 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16267 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16268 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016269
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016270fix_is_valid
16271 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16272 Information eXchange):
16273
16274 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16275 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016276 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016277 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016278 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016279 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16280 checksum
16281
16282 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16283 the server can be parsed.
16284
16285 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16286 message, false if not.
16287
16288 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16289
16290 Example:
16291 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16292 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16293
16294fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16295 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16296 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16297 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16298 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016299 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016300 added.
16301
16302 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16303 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16304 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16305 fix_is_valid converter.
16306
16307 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16308
16309 Example:
16310 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16311 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16312 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16313 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16314 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16315
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016316hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016317 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016318 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016319 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016320 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016321
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016322hex2i
16323 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016324 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016325
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016326htonl
16327 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16328 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16329 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16330 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16331
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016332hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016333 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16334 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16335 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16336 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16337
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016338 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016339 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16340
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016341http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016342 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16343 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016344 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16345 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16346 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16347 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16348 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16349 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16350 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16351 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016352
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016353iif(<true>,<false>)
16354 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16355 string otherwise.
16356
16357 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016358 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016359
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016360in_table(<table>)
16361 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16362 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16363 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016364 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016365 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16366
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016367ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016368 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016369 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016370 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16371 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16372 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16373 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16374 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016375
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016376json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016377 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016378 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016379 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016380 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16381 of errors:
16382 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16383 bytes, ...)
16384 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16385 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16386
16387 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16388 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16389 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16390 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16391 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16392 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016393 - "ascii" : never fails;
16394 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16395 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016396 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016397 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016398 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16399 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16400
16401 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016402 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016403
16404 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016405 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016406 capture request header user-agent len 150
16407 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016408
16409 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16410 GET / HTTP/1.0
16411 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16412
16413 Output log:
16414 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16415
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016416json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16417 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16418 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16419 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16420 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16421
16422 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16423 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16424
16425 Example:
16426 # get a integer value from the request body
16427 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16428 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16429
16430 # get a key with '.' in the name
16431 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16432 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16433
16434 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16435 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16436
16437 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16438 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16439
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016440language(<value>[,<default>])
16441 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16442 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16443 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16444 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16445 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16446 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16447 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16448 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16449 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016450 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016451 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16452 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016453
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016454 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016455
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016456 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16457 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016458
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016459 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16460 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16461 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16462 use_backend spanish if es
16463 use_backend french if fr
16464 use_backend english if en
16465 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016466
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016467length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016468 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16469 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16470 type. The result is of type integer.
16471
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016472lower
16473 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16474 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16475 type. The result is of type string.
16476
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016477ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16478 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16479 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16480 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16481 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16482 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16483 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16484
16485 Example :
16486
16487 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016488 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016489 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16490
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016491ltrim(<chars>)
16492 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16493 representation of the input sample.
16494
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016495map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16496map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16497map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16498 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16499 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16500 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16501 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16502 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16503 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16504 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16505 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016506
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016507 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16508 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16509 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016510
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016511 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016512 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016513
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016514 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16515 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16516 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16517 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016518 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16519 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016520 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16521 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16522 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16523 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16524 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16525 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16526 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16527 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016528 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16529 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16530 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016531 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16532 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16533 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16534 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16535 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016536
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016537 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16538 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16539 the corresponding match text.
16540
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016541 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16542 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16543 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16544 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16545 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016546
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016547 Example :
16548
16549 # this is a comment and is ignored
16550 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16551 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16552 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16553 | | | `---------- value
16554 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16555 | `---------------------------- key
16556 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16557
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016558mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016559 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16560 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016561 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016562 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016563 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016564 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16565 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16566 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16567 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016568 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016569 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016570
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016571mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016572 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16573 <packettype>.
16574 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16575 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16576 from.
16577 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16578 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16579 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16580
16581 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16582 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16583 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16584 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16585
16586 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16587 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16588 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16589 packets only):
16590 17: Session Expiry Interval
16591 33: Receive Maximum
16592 39: Maximum Packet Size
16593 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16594 25: Request Response Information
16595 23: Request Problem Information
16596 21: Authentication Method
16597 22: Authentication Data
16598 18: Will Delay Interval
16599 1: Payload Format Indicator
16600 2: Message Expiry Interval
16601 3: Content Type
16602 8: Response Topic
16603 9: Correlation Data
16604 Not supported yet:
16605 38: User Property
16606
16607 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16608 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16609 packets only):
16610 17: Session Expiry Interval
16611 33: Receive Maximum
16612 36: Maximum QoS
16613 37: Retain Available
16614 39: Maximum Packet Size
16615 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16616 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16617 31: Reason String
16618 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16619 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16620 42: Shared Subscription Available
16621 19: Server Keep Alive
16622 26: Response Information
16623 28: Server Reference
16624 21: Authentication Method
16625 22: Authentication Data
16626 Not supported yet:
16627 38: User Property
16628
16629 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16630 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16631 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16632 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16633
16634 Example:
16635
16636 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16637 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16638 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16639 if data_in_buffer
16640 # do the same as above
16641 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16642 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16643 if data_in_buffer
16644
16645mqtt_is_valid
16646 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16647
16648 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16649 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16650 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16651 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16652
16653 Example:
16654
16655 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016656 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016657
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016658mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016659 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016660 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16661 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016662 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016663 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016664 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016665 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16666 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16667 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16668 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016669 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016670 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016671
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016672nbsrv
16673 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16674 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16675 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16676 map lookup.
16677
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016678neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016679 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16680 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16681 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16682 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016683
16684not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016685 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016686 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016687 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016688 absence of a flag).
16689
16690odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016691 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016692 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16693
16694or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016695 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016696 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016697 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16698 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016699 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016700 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16701 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16702 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16703 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016704 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016705 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016706
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016707protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16708 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16709 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16710 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16711 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16712 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16713 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16714 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16715 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16716 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16717 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16718 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16719
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016720regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016721 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16722 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16723 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16724 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16725 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16726 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16727 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16728 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16729 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016730 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16731 of characters with other ones.
16732
16733 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16734 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16735 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16736 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16737 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16738 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016739
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016740 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016741
16742 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16743 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16744 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016745 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016746
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016747 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16748 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16749
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016750 # capture groups and backreferences
16751 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016752 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016753 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16754
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016755capture-req(<id>)
16756 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16757 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16758
16759 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016760 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16761 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016762
16763capture-res(<id>)
16764 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16765 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16766
16767 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016768 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16769 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016770
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016771rtrim(<chars>)
16772 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16773 of the input sample.
16774
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016775sdbm([<avalanche>])
16776 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16777 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16778 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16779 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16780 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16781 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16782 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016783 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16784 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016785
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016786secure_memcmp(<var>)
16787 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16788 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16789 match.
16790
16791 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16792 performed in constant time.
16793
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016794 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016795 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16796
16797 Example :
16798
16799 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16800 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16801 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16802 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16803
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016804set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016805 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16806 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16807 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016808 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016809 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16810 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016811 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016812 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16813 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016814 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016815 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016816
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016817sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016818 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016819 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16820
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016821sha2([<bits>])
16822 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16823 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16824
16825 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16826 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16827
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016828 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016829 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16830
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016831srv_queue
16832 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16833 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16834 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16835 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16836 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16837
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016838strcmp(<var>)
16839 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16840 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16841 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16842 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16843 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16844 shorter).
16845
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016846 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16847 strings in constant time.
16848
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016849 Example :
16850
16851 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16852 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16853 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16854
16855
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016856sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016857 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16858 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016859 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016860 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16861 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016862 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016863 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16864 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016865 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016866 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16867 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016868 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016869 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016870
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016871table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16872 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16873 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16874 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16875 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16876 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16877 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16878
16879
16880table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16881 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16882 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16883 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16884 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16885 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16886 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16887
16888table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16889 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16890 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016891 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016892 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16893 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16894
16895table_conn_cur(<table>)
16896 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16897 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16898 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16899 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16900 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16901
16902table_conn_rate(<table>)
16903 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16904 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16905 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16906 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16907 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16908
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020016909table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
16910 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
16911 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16912 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
16913 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
16914 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
16915 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
16916 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
16917 data-type).
16918 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
16919
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016920table_gpt0(<table>)
16921 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16922 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16923 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16924 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16925 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16926
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020016927table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
16928 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
16929 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16930 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
16931 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
16932 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
16933 between 0 and 99.
16934 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
16935 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
16936 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
16937 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
16938
16939table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
16940 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
16941 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16942 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
16943 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
16944 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
16945 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
16946 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
16947 value 0.
16948 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
16949 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
16950 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
16951
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016952table_gpc0(<table>)
16953 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16954 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16955 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16956 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16957 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16958
16959table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16960 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16961 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16962 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16963 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16964 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16965 sample fetch keyword.
16966
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016967table_gpc1(<table>)
16968 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16969 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16970 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16971 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16972 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16973
16974table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16975 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16976 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16977 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16978 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16979 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16980 sample fetch keyword.
16981
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016982table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16983 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16984 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016985 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016986 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16987 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16988
16989table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16990 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16991 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16992 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16993 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16994 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16995 keyword.
16996
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016997table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16998 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16999 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17000 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
17001 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17002 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17003
17004table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
17005 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17006 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17007 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
17008 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
17009 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
17010 keyword.
17011
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017012table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
17013 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17014 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017015 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017016 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17017 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17018
17019table_http_req_rate(<table>)
17020 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17021 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17022 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
17023 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
17024 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
17025 keyword.
17026
17027table_kbytes_in(<table>)
17028 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17029 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017030 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017031 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17032 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17033 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
17034 keyword.
17035
17036table_kbytes_out(<table>)
17037 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17038 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017039 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017040 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17041 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17042 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
17043 keyword.
17044
17045table_server_id(<table>)
17046 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17047 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17048 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17049 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17050 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17051 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17052
17053table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17054 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17055 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017056 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017057 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17058 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17059 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17060 keyword.
17061
17062table_sess_rate(<table>)
17063 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17064 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17065 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17066 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17067 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17068 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17069 keyword.
17070
17071table_trackers(<table>)
17072 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17073 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17074 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17075 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17076 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17077 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17078 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17079 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17080 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17081 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17082
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017083ub64dec
17084 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17085 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17086 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17087
17088 Example:
17089 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17090 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17091
17092ub64enc
17093 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17094
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017095upper
17096 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17097 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17098 type. The result is of type string.
17099
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017100url_dec([<in_form>])
17101 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17102 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17103 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17104 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17105 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17106 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017107
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017108url_enc([<enc_type>])
17109 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17110 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17111 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17112 optional argument is here for future changes.
17113
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017114ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017115 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017116 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17117 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17118 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017119 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17120 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17121 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17122 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017123 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017124 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17125 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017126
17127 Example:
17128 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17129 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17130
17131 message Point {
17132 int32 latitude = 1;
17133 int32 longitude = 2;
17134 }
17135
17136 message PPoint {
17137 Point point = 59;
17138 }
17139
17140 message Rectangle {
17141 // One corner of the rectangle.
17142 PPoint lo = 48;
17143 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17144 PPoint hi = 49;
17145 }
17146
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017147 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17148 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17149 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017150
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017151 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17152 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017153 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017154 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17155
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017156 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017157
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017158 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017159
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017160 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17161 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17162 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017163
17164 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17165 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17166 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17167
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017168 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17169 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17170 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017171
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017172
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017173unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017174 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17175 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17176 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17177 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17178 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17179 response),
17180 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17181 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17182 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17183 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17184
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017185utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17186 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17187 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17188 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17189 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17190 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17191 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17192
17193 Example :
17194
17195 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017196 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017197 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17198
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017199word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17200 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17201 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17202 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017203 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017204 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17205 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17206
17207 Example :
17208 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17209 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17210 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17211 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17212 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017213 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017214
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017215wt6([<avalanche>])
17216 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17217 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17218 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17219 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17220 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17221 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17222 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017223 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17224 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017225
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017226xor(<value>)
17227 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017228 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017229 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017230 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017231 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017232 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17233 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017234 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017235 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17236 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017237 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017238 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017239
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017240xxh3([<seed>])
17241 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17242 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17243 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17244 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17245 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17246 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17247 considered as cryptographically secure.
17248
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017249xxh32([<seed>])
17250 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17251 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17252 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17253 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17254 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17255 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17256 as cryptographically secure.
17257
17258xxh64([<seed>])
17259 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17260 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17261 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17262 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17263 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17264 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17265 as cryptographically secure.
17266
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017267
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200172687.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017269--------------------------------------------
17270
17271A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17272not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17273"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17274The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17275
17276always_false : boolean
17277 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17278 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17279
17280always_true : boolean
17281 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17282 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17283
17284avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017285 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017286 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17287 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17288 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17289 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17290 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17291 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17292 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17293 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17294 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17295 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17296 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17297 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17298 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017300be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017301 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17302 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17303 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17304 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017305 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17306
17307be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17308 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17309 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17310 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17311 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17312 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017313 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17314 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017315
17316 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17317 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17318 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017320be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17321 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17322 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17323 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017324 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017325 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17326 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017327
17328 Example :
17329 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17330 backend dynamic
17331 mode http
17332 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17333 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017334
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017335bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017336 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17337 of the string.
17338
17339bool(<bool>) : bool
17340 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17341 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017343connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17344 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017345 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017346 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17347 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017348
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017349 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017350 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017351 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17352
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017353 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17354 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017355
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017356 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017357 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017358 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017359 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017360 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017361 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017362 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017363
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017364 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17365 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017366 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017367 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017368
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017369cpu_calls : integer
17370 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17371 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17372 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17373 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17374 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17375 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17376
17377cpu_ns_avg : integer
17378 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17379 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17380 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17381 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17382 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17383 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17384 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17385 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17386 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17387 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17388 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17389
17390cpu_ns_tot : integer
17391 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17392 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17393 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17394 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17395 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17396 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17397 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17398 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17399 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17400 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17401 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17402 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17403 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17404
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017405date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017406 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017407
17408 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17409 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17410 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017411 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17412
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017413 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17414 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17415 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17416 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17417 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17418
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017419 Example :
17420
17421 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17422 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017423
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017424 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17425 # millisecond granularity
17426 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17427
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017428date_us : integer
17429 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17430 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17431 from the same timeval structure.
17432
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017433distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17434 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17435 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17436 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17437 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017438 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017439 list of supported tokens.
17440
17441distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17442 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17443 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17444 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17445 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017446 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017447 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17448 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17449 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17450 supported tokens.
17451
17452 Example :
17453 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17454 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17455 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17456 # send large files to the big farm
17457 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17458
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017459env(<name>) : string
17460 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17461 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17462 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17463 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17464 certain way.
17465
17466 Examples :
17467 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17468 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17469
17470 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17471 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017473fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17474 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017475 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17476 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017477 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17478 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017479 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017480 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17481 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017482
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017483fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17484 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17485 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17486 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017488fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17489 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17490 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17491 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17492 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17493 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17494 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17495 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17496 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017497
17498 Example :
17499 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17500 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17501 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17502 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17503 frontend mail
17504 bind :25
17505 mode tcp
17506 maxconn 100
17507 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17508 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17509 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17510 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017511
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017512hostname : string
17513 Returns the system hostname.
17514
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017515int(<integer>) : signed integer
17516 Returns a signed integer.
17517
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017518ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17519 Returns an ipv4.
17520
17521ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17522 Returns an ipv6.
17523
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017524lat_ns_avg : integer
17525 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17526 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17527 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17528 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17529 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17530 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17531 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17532 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17533 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017534 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17535 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17536 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17537 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17538 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17539 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017540
17541lat_ns_tot : integer
17542 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17543 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17544 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17545 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17546 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17547 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17548 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17549 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17550 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017551 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17552 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17553 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17554 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17555 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017556 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17557 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17558 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17559 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17560 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17561 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17562
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017563meth(<method>) : method
17564 Returns a method.
17565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017566nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17567 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17568 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17569 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017570 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17571 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17572 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017573
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017574prio_class : integer
17575 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17576 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17577 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17578
17579prio_offset : integer
17580 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17581 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17582 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17583 set-priority-offset".
17584
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017585proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020017586 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
17587 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017589queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017590 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17591 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17592 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017593 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17594 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17595 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17596 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17597 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17598
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017599rand([<range>]) : integer
17600 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17601 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17602 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17603 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17604 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017606srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17607 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17608 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17609 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17610 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17611 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017612 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17613 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17614
17615srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17616 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17617 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17618 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17619 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17620 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17621 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17622 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17623
17624 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17625 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017626
17627srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17628 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17629 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17630 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017631 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017632 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17633 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17634 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17635
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017636srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17637 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17638 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17639 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17640 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17641 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17642 fetch methods.
17643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017644srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17645 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17646 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017647 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017648 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17649 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017650 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017651 overloading servers).
17652
17653 Example :
17654 # Redirect to a separate back
17655 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17656 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17657 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17658
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017659srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017660 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17661 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17662 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17663
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017664srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017665 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17666 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17667 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17668
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017669srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017670 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17671 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17672 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17673
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017674stopping : boolean
17675 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17676 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17677 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17678
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017679str(<string>) : string
17680 Returns a string.
17681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017682table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17683 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17684 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17685
17686table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17687 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17688 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17689 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17690
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017691thread : integer
17692 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17693 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17694 and debugging purposes.
17695
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017696uuid([<version>]) : string
17697 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17698 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17699 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17700
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017701var(<var-name>) : undefined
17702 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017703 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17704 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017705 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017706 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17707 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017708 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017709 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17710 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017711 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017712 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017713
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200177147.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017715----------------------------------
17716
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017717The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017718closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17719methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17720sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17721TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017722the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17723counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017724"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17725used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17726can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17727Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17728table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17729tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17730currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017731
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017732bc_dst : ip
17733 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17734 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17735 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17736 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17737
17738bc_dst_port : integer
17739 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017740 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017741
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017742bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017743 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17744 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17745 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17746
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017747bc_src : ip
17748 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017749 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017750 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17751 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17752
17753bc_src_port : integer
17754 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017755 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017757be_id : integer
17758 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017759 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17760 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017761
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017762be_name : string
17763 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017764 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17765 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017766
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017767be_server_timeout : integer
17768 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17769 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17770 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17771
17772be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17773 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17774 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17775 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17776
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017777cur_server_timeout : integer
17778 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17779 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17780 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17781
17782cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17783 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17784 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17785 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017787dst : ip
17788 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17789 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17790 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17791 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017792 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17793 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17794 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17795 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17796 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17797 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017798
17799dst_conn : integer
17800 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17801 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17802 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17803 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17804 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17805 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17806 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17807 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017808
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017809dst_is_local : boolean
17810 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17811 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17812 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17813 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017814 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017815 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17816 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17817 it only once per connection.
17818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017819dst_port : integer
17820 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17821 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17822 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17823 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17824 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17825 an HTTP header.
17826
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020017827fc_conn_err : integer
17828 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
17829 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
17830 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050017831 described in section 8.2.5). See the "fc_conn_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020017832 error codes and their corresponding error message.
17833
17834fc_conn_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050017835 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020017836 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
17837 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.5). See below for a
17838 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
17839
17840 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
17841 | ID | message |
17842 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
17843 | 0 | "Success" |
17844 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
17845 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
17846 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
17847 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
17848 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
17849 | 6 | "General socket error" |
17850 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
17851 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
17852 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
17853 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
17854 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
17855 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
17856 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
17857 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
17858 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
17859 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
17860 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
17861 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
17862 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
17863 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
17864 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
17865 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
17866 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
17867 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
17868 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
17869 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
17870 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
17871 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
17872 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
17873 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
17874 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
17875 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
17876 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
17877 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
17878 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
17879 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
17880 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
17881 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
17882 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
17883 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
17884 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
17885 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
17886 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
17887
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017888fc_http_major : integer
17889 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17890 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17891 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17892
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017893fc_pp_authority : string
17894 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17895 if any.
17896
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017897fc_pp_unique_id : string
17898 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17899 if any.
17900
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017901fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17902 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17903 header.
17904
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017905fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17906 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17907 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17908 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17909 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17910 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17911 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17912
17913fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17914 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17915 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17916 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17917 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17918 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17919 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17920
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017921fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017922 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17923 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17924 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17925 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17926
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017927fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017928 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17929 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17930 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17931 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17932
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017933fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017934 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17935 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17936 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17937 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17938
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017939fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017940 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17941 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17942 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17943 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17944
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017945fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017946 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17947 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17948 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17949 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17950
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017951fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017952 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17953 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17954 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17955 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17956
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017957fe_defbe : string
17958 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17959 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017961fe_id : integer
17962 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017963 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017964 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17965
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017966fe_name : string
17967 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17968 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17969 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17970
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017971fe_client_timeout : integer
17972 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17973 current frontend.
17974
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017975sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017976sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17977sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17978sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017979 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17980 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17981 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17982
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017983sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017984sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17985sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17986sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017987 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17988 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17989 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17990
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020017991sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17992 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
17993 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
17994 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
17995 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
17996 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
17997 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
17998 will always return zero.
17999 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18000 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18001
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018002sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018003sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18004sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18005sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018006 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18007 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018008 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18009 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18010 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018011
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018012 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018013 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18014 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018015 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18016 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
18017 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018018 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18019 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18020
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018021sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18022sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18023sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18024sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18025 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18026 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
18027 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18028 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18029 when a first ACL was verified.
18030
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018031sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018032sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18033sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18034sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018035 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018036 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
18037
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018038sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018039sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18040sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18041sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018042 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18043 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
18044 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
18045
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018046sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018047sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18048sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18049sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018050 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
18051 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
18052 See also src_conn_rate.
18053
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018054sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18055 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
18056 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
18057 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
18058 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18059 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
18060 index, zero is returned.
18061 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18062 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
18063
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018064sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018065sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18066sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18067sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018068 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018069 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018070
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018071sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18072sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18073sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18074sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18075 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18076 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18077
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018078sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18079 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18080 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
18081 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18082 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18083 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
18084 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
18085 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
18086
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018087sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18088sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18089sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18090sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18091 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18092 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
18093
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018094sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18095 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18096 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
18097 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
18098 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
18099 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
18100 between 0 and 2.
18101 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
18102 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18103 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18104 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18105 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18106
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018107sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018108sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18109sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18110sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018111 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
18112 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18113 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018114 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18115 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18116 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018117
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018118sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18119sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18120sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18121sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18122 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18123 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18124 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18125 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18126 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18127 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18128
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018129sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018130sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18131sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18132sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018133 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018134 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
18135 See also src_http_err_cnt.
18136
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018137sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018138sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18139sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18140sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018141 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18142 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18143 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18144 src_http_err_rate.
18145
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018146sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18147sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18148sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18149sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18150 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18151 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18152 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18153
18154sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18155sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18156sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18157sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18158 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18159 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18160 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18161 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18162
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018163sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018164sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18165sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18166sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018167 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018168 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18169 src_http_req_cnt.
18170
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018171sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018172sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18173sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18174sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018175 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18176 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18177 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18178 src_http_req_rate.
18179
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018180sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18181 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18182 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18183 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18184 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18185 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18186 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18187 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
18188 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18189 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18190
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018191sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018192sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18193sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18194sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018195 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018196 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18197 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18198 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18199 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018200
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018201 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018202 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18203 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018204 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18205
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018206sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18207sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18208sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18209sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18210 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18211 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18212 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18213 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18214 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18215
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018216sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018217sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18218sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18219sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018220 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18221 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18222 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018223
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018224sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018225sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18226sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18227sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018228 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18229 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18230 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018231
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018232sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018233sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18234sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18235sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018236 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018237 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18238 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18239 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018240 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018241 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18242
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018243sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018244sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18245sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18246sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018247 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18248 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18249 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18250 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18251 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018252 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018253
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018254sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018255sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18256sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18257sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018258 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18259 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18260 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18261
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018262sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018263sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18264sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18265sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018266 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18267 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018268 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018269 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18270 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018271 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18272 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18273 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018275so_id : integer
18276 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18277 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18278 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018279
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018280so_name : string
18281 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18282 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18283 strings instead of integers.
18284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018285src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018286 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018287 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18288 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18289 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018290 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18291 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18292 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018293 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18294 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18295 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18296 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18297 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18298 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18299 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018300
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018301 Example:
18302 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18303 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018305src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18306 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18307 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18308 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018309 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018311src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18312 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18313 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018314 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018315 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018316
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018317src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18318 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18319 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18320 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
18321 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18322 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
18323 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18324 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18325 See also sc_clr_gpc.
18326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018327src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18328 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18329 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18330 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18331 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18332 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18333 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018334
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018335 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018336 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18337 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18338 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18339 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018340 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018341 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18342 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18343
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018344src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18345 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18346 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18347 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18348 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18349 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18350 was verified.
18351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018352src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018353 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018354 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018355 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018356 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018358src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018359 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018360 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18361 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018362 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018364src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18365 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18366 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18367 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018368 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018369
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018370src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18371 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
18372 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18373 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18374 is an integer between 0 and 99.
18375 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
18376 is returned.
18377 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
18378 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18379 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
18380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018381src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018382 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018383 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018384 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018385 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018386
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018387src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18388 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18389 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18390 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18391 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18392
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018393src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18394 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18395 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18396 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
18397 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18398 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
18399 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
18400
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018401src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18402 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18403 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18404 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18405 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18406
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018407src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18408 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18409 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
18410 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18411 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
18412 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18413 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
18414 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18415 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18416 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18417 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018419src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018420 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018421 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018422 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18423 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018424 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18425 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18426 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018427
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018428src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18429 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18430 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18431 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18432 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18433 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18434 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18435 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018437src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018438 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018439 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018440 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018441 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018442 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018444src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18445 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18446 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18447 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18448 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018449 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018450
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018451src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18452 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18453 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018454 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018455 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18456 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18457
18458src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18459 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18460 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18461 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18462 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18463 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18464 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018466src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018467 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018468 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18469 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018470 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018472src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18473 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18474 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18475 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018476 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018477 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018478
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018479src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18480 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
18481 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18482 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
18483 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18484 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
18485 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18486 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18487 See also sc_inc_gpc.
18488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018489src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18490 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18491 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18492 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018493 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018494 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18495 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018496
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018497 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018498 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018499 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018500 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018501
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018502src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18503 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18504 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18505 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18506 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18507 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18508 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18509
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018510src_is_local : boolean
18511 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18512 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18513 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18514 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018515 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018516 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18517 once per connection.
18518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018519src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018520 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18521 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18522 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18523 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18524 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018526src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018527 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18528 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18529 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18530 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18531 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018533src_port : integer
18534 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18535 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18536 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18537 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018539src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018540 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018541 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18542 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18543 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018544 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018546src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18547 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18548 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18549 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18550 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018551 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018553src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18554 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18555 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18556 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18557 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18558 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18559 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18560 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18561 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018562
18563 Example :
18564 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18565 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18566 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18567 listen ssh
18568 bind :22
18569 mode tcp
18570 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018571 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018572 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018573 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018575srv_id : integer
18576 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18577 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018578 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018579
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018580srv_name : string
18581 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18582 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018583 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018584
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200185857.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018586----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018587
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018588The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018589closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18590when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18591usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018592future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018593
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001859451d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18595 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18596 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18597 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18598 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18599 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18600
18601 Example :
18602 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18603 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18604 # the request.
18605 frontend http-in
18606 bind *:8081
18607 default_backend servers
18608 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18609 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18610
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018611ssl_bc : boolean
18612 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18613 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018614 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18615 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018616
18617ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18618 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018619 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18620 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018621
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018622ssl_bc_alpn : string
18623 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18624 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018625 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018626 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18627 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18628 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18629 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18630 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018631 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18632 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018633
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018634ssl_bc_cipher : string
18635 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018636 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18637 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018638
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018639ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18640 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18641 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18642 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018643 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018644
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018645ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18646 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18647 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018648 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18649 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018650
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018651ssl_bc_npn : string
18652 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18653 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018654 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018655 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18656 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18657 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18658 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018659 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18660 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018661
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018662ssl_bc_protocol : string
18663 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018664 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18665 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018666
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018667ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018668 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018669 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018670 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18671 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018672
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018673ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18674 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18675 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18676 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018677 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018678
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018679ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18680 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18681 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018682 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18683 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018684
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018685ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18686 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18687 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18688 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018689 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018690
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018691ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18692 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018693 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18694 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018696ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18697 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18698 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18699 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18700 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18701 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018703ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18704 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18705 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18706 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18707 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018708
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018709ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018710 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18711 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18712 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018713 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018714 does not support resumed sessions.
18715
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018716ssl_c_der : binary
18717 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18718 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18719 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018721ssl_c_err : integer
18722 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18723 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18724 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18725 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18726 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018727
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018728ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018729 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18730 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18731 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18732 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18733 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18734 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18735 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18736 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018737 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18738 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18739 LDAP v3.
18740 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18741 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018743ssl_c_key_alg : string
18744 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18745 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18746 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018748ssl_c_notafter : string
18749 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18750 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18751 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018753ssl_c_notbefore : string
18754 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18755 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18756 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018757
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018758ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018759 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18760 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18761 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18762 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18763 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18764 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18765 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18766 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018767 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18768 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18769 LDAP v3.
18770 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18771 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018773ssl_c_serial : binary
18774 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18775 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18776 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018778ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18779 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18780 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18781 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018782 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18783 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18784
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018785 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018786 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018788ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18789 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18790 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18791 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018793ssl_c_used : boolean
18794 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18795 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018797ssl_c_verify : integer
18798 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18799 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18800 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18801 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018803ssl_c_version : integer
18804 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18805 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018806
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018807ssl_f_der : binary
18808 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18809 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18810 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18811
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018812ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018813 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18814 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18815 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18816 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018817 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018818 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18819 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18820 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018821 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18822 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18823 LDAP v3.
18824 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18825 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018827ssl_f_key_alg : string
18828 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18829 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18830 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018832ssl_f_notafter : string
18833 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18834 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18835 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018837ssl_f_notbefore : string
18838 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18839 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18840 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018841
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018842ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018843 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18844 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18845 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18846 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18847 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18848 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18849 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18850 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018851 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18852 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18853 LDAP v3.
18854 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18855 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018857ssl_f_serial : binary
18858 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18859 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18860 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018861
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018862ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18863 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18864 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18865 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018867ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18868 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18869 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18870 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018872ssl_f_version : integer
18873 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18874 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18875
18876ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018877 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18878 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18879 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018881 Example :
18882 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18883 listen http-https
18884 bind :80
18885 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18886 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18887
18888ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18889 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18890 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18891
18892ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018893 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018894 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018895 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018896 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18897 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18898 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18899 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18900 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18901 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018903ssl_fc_cipher : string
18904 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18905 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018906
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018907ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
18908 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18909 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020018910 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018911 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
18912 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
18913 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018914
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018915 Example:
18916 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
18917 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18918 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18919 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18920 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
18921 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
18922 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
18923 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
18924 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
18925
18926ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018927 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018928 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020018929 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
18930 Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018931 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
18932 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018933
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018934ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018935 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018936 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020018937 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018938 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
18939 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
18940 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
18941 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
18942 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
18943 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018944
18945ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018946 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020018947 "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash take
18948 into account all the data of the cipher list.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018949
18950ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
18951 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
18952 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020018953 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018954
18955 Example:
18956 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
18957 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18958 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18959 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18960 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
18961 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
18962 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
18963 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
18964 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
18965
18966ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
18967 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
18968 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020018969 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018970 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
18971 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
18972 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
18973
18974 Example:
18975 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
18976 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18977 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18978 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18979 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
18980 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
18981 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
18982 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
18983 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
18984
18985ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
18986 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
18987 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020018988 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018989 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
18990 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
18991 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
18992
18993 Example:
18994 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
18995 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18996 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18997 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18998 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
18999 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19000 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19001 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19002 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019003
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019004ssl_fc_client_random : binary
19005 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19006 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19007 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19008
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019009ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
19010 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19011 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19012 transport layer.
19013 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19014 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19015 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19016 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19017
19018ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19019 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19020 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19021 transport layer.
19022 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19023 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19024 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19025 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19026
19027ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
19028 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19029 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19030 transport layer.
19031 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19032 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19033 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19034 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19035
19036ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
19037 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19038 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19039 transport layer.
19040 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19041 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19042 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19043 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19044
19045ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
19046 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19047 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19048 transport layer.
19049 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19050 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19051 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19052 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019054ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019055 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
19056 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010019057 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
19058 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
19059 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
19060 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019061
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020019062ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
19063 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
19064 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
19065 wait until the handshake happened.
19066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019067ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
19068 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019069 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
19070 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019071 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019072 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019073
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c6898e2021-07-29 09:45:51 +020019074ssl_fc_hsk_err : integer
19075 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19076 returns the ID of the latest error that happened during the handshake on the
19077 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. Any error happening during
19078 the client's certificate verification process will not be raised through this
19079 fetch but via the existing "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and
19080 "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get a text description of this
19081 error code, you can either use the "ssl_fc_hsk_err_str" sample fetch or use
19082 the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code in hexadecimal
19083 representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL library's
19084 documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
19085
19086ssl_fc_hsk_err_str : string
19087 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19088 returns a string representation of the latest error that happened during the
19089 handshake on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
19090 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
19091 also "ssl_fc_hsk_err".
19092
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020019093ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019094 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010019095 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
19096 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019098ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019099 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019100 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019101 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
19102 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
19103 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
19104 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
19105 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
19106 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020019107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019108ssl_fc_protocol : string
19109 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
19110 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019111
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019112ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
19113 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
19114 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019115 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than
19116 0.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019117
19118 Example:
19119 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19120 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19121 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19122 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19123 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19124 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19125 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19126 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19127 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19128
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019129ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019130 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019131 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
19132 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019133
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019134ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19135 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19136 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19137 transport layer.
19138 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19139 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19140 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19141 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19142
19143ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
19144 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19145 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19146 transport layer.
19147 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19148 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19149 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19150 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19151
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019152ssl_fc_server_random : binary
19153 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19154 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19155 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019157ssl_fc_session_id : binary
19158 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
19159 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
19160 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
19161 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019162
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019163ssl_fc_session_key : binary
19164 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
19165 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
19166 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
19167 BoringSSL.
19168
19169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019170ssl_fc_sni : string
19171 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
19172 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019173 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019174 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
19175 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
19176
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019177 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019178 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019179 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019180 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020019181 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019183 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019184 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
19185 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020019186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019187ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
19188 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
19189 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019190
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019191ssl_s_der : binary
19192 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
19193 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19194 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19195
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019196ssl_s_chain_der : binary
19197 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
19198 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19199 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019200 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019201 does not support resumed sessions.
19202
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019203ssl_s_key_alg : string
19204 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19205 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
19206 SSL/TLS transport layer.
19207
19208ssl_s_notafter : string
19209 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
19210 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19211 transport layer.
19212
19213ssl_s_notbefore : string
19214 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
19215 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19216 transport layer.
19217
19218ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19219 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19220 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19221 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19222 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19223 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19224 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019225 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19226 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019227 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19228 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19229 LDAP v3.
19230 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19231 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19232
19233ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19234 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19235 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19236 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19237 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19238 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19239 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019240 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19241 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019242 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19243 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19244 LDAP v3.
19245 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19246 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19247
19248ssl_s_serial : binary
19249 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
19250 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19251 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19252
19253ssl_s_sha1 : binary
19254 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
19255 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19256 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19257
19258ssl_s_sig_alg : string
19259 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19260 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19261 layer.
19262
19263ssl_s_version : integer
19264 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
19265 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019266
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200192677.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019268------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019270Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
19271sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
19272only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
19273For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
19274be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
19275can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
19276sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
19277for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
19278content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019279
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019280Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
19281 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019282 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019283 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
19284 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
19285 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
19286 sample expression). So be careful.
19287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019288payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019289 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019290 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
19291 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019293payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
19294 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019295 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019296 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019298req.len : integer
19299req_len : integer (deprecated)
19300 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19301 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19302 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19303 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19304 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019305 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019306 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
19307 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019309req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19310 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019311 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
19312 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
19313 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
19314 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019316 ACL alternatives :
19317 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019319req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19320 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19321 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19322 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19323 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019325 ACL alternatives :
19326 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019328 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019330req.proto_http : boolean
19331req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19332 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19333 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19334 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19335 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19336 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19337 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19338 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019340 Example:
19341 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19342 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19343 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019344 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019346req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19347rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19348 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19349 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19350 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19351 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19352 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19353 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19354 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019356 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19357 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19358 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19359 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19360 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19361 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019363 ACL derivatives :
19364 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019366 Example :
19367 listen tse-farm
19368 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19369 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19370 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19371 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19372 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19373 persist rdp-cookie
19374 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19375 # This is only useful makes sense if
19376 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19377 stick-table type string size 204800
19378 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19379 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19380 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019382 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
19383 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019385req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19386rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19387 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19388 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19389 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19390 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019392 ACL derivatives :
19393 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019394
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019395req.ssl_alpn : string
19396 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19397 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19398 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19399 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19400 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19401 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019402 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019403
19404 Examples :
19405 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19406 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19407 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019408 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019409 default_backend bk_default
19410
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019411req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19412 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19413 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019414 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19415 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19416 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19417 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19418 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019420req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19421req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19422 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19423 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19424 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19425 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19426 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19427 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19428 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019430req.ssl_sni : string
19431req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19432 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19433 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19434 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19435 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19436 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019437 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19438 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19439 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19440 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19441 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19442 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19443 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19444 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19445 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019447 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019448 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019450 Examples :
19451 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19452 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19453 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019454 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019455 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019456
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019457req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19458 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19459 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19460 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19461 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19462 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19463 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19464 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19465 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19466 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019468req.ssl_ver : integer
19469req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19470 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19471 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19472 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19473 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19474 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19475 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19476 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019477 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019478 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019480 ACL derivatives :
19481 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019482
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019483res.len : integer
19484 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19485 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19486 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19487 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19488 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019489 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019490 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019491 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019493res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19494 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019495 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019496 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019497 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019498 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019500res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19501 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19502 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19503 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019504 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19505 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019507 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019508
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019509res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19510rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19511 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19512 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19513 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19514 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19515 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19516 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19517 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019519wait_end : boolean
19520 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19521 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019522 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019523 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19524 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019525 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019526 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19527 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019529 Examples :
19530 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19531 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19532 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019534 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19535 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19536 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19537 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19538 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19539 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19540 tcp-request content reject
19541
19542
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200195437.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019544--------------------------------------
19545
19546It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19547This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19548data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19549its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19550HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19551content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19552to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19553more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19554response are indexed.
19555
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019556Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19557 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19558 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19559 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19560 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19561 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19562 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019564base : string
19565 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19566 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19567 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19568 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19569 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19570 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19571 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19572 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19573
19574 ACL derivatives :
19575 base : exact string match
19576 base_beg : prefix match
19577 base_dir : subdir match
19578 base_dom : domain match
19579 base_end : suffix match
19580 base_len : length match
19581 base_reg : regex match
19582 base_sub : substring match
19583
19584base32 : integer
19585 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19586 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19587 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019588 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19589 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19590 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019591
19592base32+src : binary
19593 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19594 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19595 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19596 per-URL counters.
19597
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019598baseq : string
19599 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19600 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19601 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19602 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19603
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019604capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19605 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19606 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19607 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19608
19609capture.req.method : string
19610 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19611 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19612 because it's allocated.
19613
19614capture.req.uri : string
19615 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19616 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19617 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19618 allocated.
19619
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019620capture.req.ver : string
19621 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19622 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19623 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19624
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019625capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19626 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19627 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19628 The first entry is an index of 0.
19629 See also: "capture response header"
19630
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019631capture.res.ver : string
19632 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19633 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19634 persistent flag.
19635
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019636req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019637 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19638 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19639 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019640
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019641req.body_param([<name>) : string
19642 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19643 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19644 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19645 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19646 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19647 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19648 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19649 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19650 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19651 given.
19652
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019653req.body_len : integer
19654 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19655 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019656 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19657 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019658
19659req.body_size : integer
19660 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019661 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19662 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019664req.cook([<name>]) : string
19665cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19666 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19667 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19668 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19669 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19670 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19671 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19672 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19673 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19674
19675 ACL derivatives :
19676 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19677 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19678 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19679 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19680 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19681 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19682 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19683 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019685req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19686cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19687 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19688 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019690req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19691cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19692 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19693 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19694 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19695 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019697cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19698 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19699 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19700 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19701 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019702 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019703 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19704 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19705 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19706 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019708hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19709 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19710 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19711 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19712 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019713 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019715req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019716 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19717 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19718 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19719 with headers such as User-Agent.
19720
19721 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19722 found.
19723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019724 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19725 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19726 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019727 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019729req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19730 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19731 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019732 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19733 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019735req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019736 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19737 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19738 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19739 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19740 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19741 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19742 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19743
19744 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19745 found.
19746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019747 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19748 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19749 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019750 with -1 being the last one.
19751
19752 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19753 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019755 ACL derivatives :
19756 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19757 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19758 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19759 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19760 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19761 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19762 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19763 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19764
19765req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19766hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19767 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19768 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019769 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19770 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19771 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19772
19773 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19774 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19775 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19776
19777 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019778
19779req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19780hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19781 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19782 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19783 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019784 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19785 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19786 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19787 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19788 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019789
19790 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19791
19792 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019793
19794req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19795hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19796 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19797 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19798 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019799
19800 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19801
19802 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019803
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019804req.hdrs : string
19805 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19806 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19807 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19808 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19809
19810req.hdrs_bin : binary
19811 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19812 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19813 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19814 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19815 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19816 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19817
19818 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019819
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019820 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19821 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019823http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19824 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19825 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19826 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19827 basic auth is supported.
19828
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019829http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19830 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19831 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19832 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19833 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019834 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19835 basic auth is supported.
19836
19837 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019838 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19839 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19840 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19841 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019842
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019843http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019844 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19845 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19846 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019847
19848http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019849 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19850 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19851 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019852
19853http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019854 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19855 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19856 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019858http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019859 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19860 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019861 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19862 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019864method : integer + string
19865 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19866 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19867 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19868 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19869 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19870 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19871 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019873 ACL derivatives :
19874 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019876 Example :
19877 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19878 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19879 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019881path : string
19882 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19883 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19884 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19885 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19886 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019887 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019888 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019890 ACL derivatives :
19891 path : exact string match
19892 path_beg : prefix match
19893 path_dir : subdir match
19894 path_dom : domain match
19895 path_end : suffix match
19896 path_len : length match
19897 path_reg : regex match
19898 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019899
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019900pathq : string
19901 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19902 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19903 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19904 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19905 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19906 result in both cases.
19907
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019908query : string
19909 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19910 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19911 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19912 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019913 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019914 which stops before the question mark.
19915
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019916req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19917 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19918 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19919 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19920 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019922req.ver : string
19923req_ver : string (deprecated)
19924 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19925 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19926 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019928 ACL derivatives :
19929 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019930
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019931res.body : binary
19932 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19933 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019934 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19935
19936 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019937
19938res.body_len : integer
19939 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19940 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019941 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19942
19943 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019944
19945res.body_size : integer
19946 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19947 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19948 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19949 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019950 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19951
19952 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019953
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019954res.cache_hit : boolean
19955 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19956 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19957
19958res.cache_name : string
19959 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19960 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19961 empty string.
19962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019963res.comp : boolean
19964 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19965 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19966 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019968res.comp_algo : string
19969 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19970 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19971 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019973res.cook([<name>]) : string
19974scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19975 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19976 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019977 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19978
19979 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019981 ACL derivatives :
19982 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019984res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19985scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19986 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19987 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019988 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19989
19990 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019992res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19993scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19994 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19995 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019996 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19997
19998 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020000res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020001 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20002 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20003
20004 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
20005 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
20006
20007 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
20008
20009 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020011res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020012 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20013 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20014
20015 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
20016 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
20017
20018 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020020res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
20021shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020022 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20023 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20024
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020025 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020026 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
20027
20028 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020030 ACL derivatives :
20031 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
20032 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
20033 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
20034 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
20035 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
20036 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
20037 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
20038 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
20039
20040res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20041shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020042 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20043 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20044
20045 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020046 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020047
20048 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020050res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
20051shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020052 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
20053 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20054
20055 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20056
20057 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020058
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020059res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
20060 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
20061 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
20062 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020063 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
20064
20065 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020067res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
20068shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020069 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
20070 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20071
20072 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20073
20074 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020075
20076res.hdrs : string
20077 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
20078 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
20079 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020080 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
20081
20082 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020083
20084res.hdrs_bin : binary
20085 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
20086 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
20087 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
20088 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
20089 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
20090 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
20091 (length of 0 for both).
20092
20093 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
20094
20095 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
20096 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020098res.ver : string
20099resp_ver : string (deprecated)
20100 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020101 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
20102
20103 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020105 ACL derivatives :
20106 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020108set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20109 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20110 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020020111 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020112 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020114 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
20115 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020117status : integer
20118 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
20119 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020120 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
20121
20122 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020123
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020020124unique-id : string
20125 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
20126 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
20127 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
20128 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
20129 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
20130 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
20131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020132url : string
20133 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
20134 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
20135 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
20136 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
20137 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
20138 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
20139 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020141 ACL derivatives :
20142 url : exact string match
20143 url_beg : prefix match
20144 url_dir : subdir match
20145 url_dom : domain match
20146 url_end : suffix match
20147 url_len : length match
20148 url_reg : regex match
20149 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020151url_ip : ip
20152 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
20153 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
20154 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
20155 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020156 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
20157 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020159url_port : integer
20160 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020161 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020162
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020163urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
20164url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020165 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
20166 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020167 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
20168 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
20169 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
20170 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020171 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
20172 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020173 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
20174 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020176 ACL derivatives :
20177 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
20178 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
20179 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
20180 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
20181 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
20182 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
20183 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
20184 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020185
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020187 Example :
20188 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
20189 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
20190 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
20191 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020192
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020193urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020194 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
20195 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
20196 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020020197
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020020198url32 : integer
20199 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
20200 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
20201 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
20202 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
20203 is an unsigned integer.
20204
20205url32+src : binary
20206 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
20207 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
20208 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
20209
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020020210
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200202117.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020212---------------------------------------
20213
20214This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
20215used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
20216purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
20217There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
20218or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
20219any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
20220for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
20221
20222internal.htx.data : integer
20223 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
20224 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20225
20226internal.htx.free : integer
20227 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
20228 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20229
20230internal.htx.free_data : integer
20231 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
20232 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20233
20234internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010020235 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
20236 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
20237 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020238
20239internal.htx.nbblks : integer
20240 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
20241 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20242
20243internal.htx.size : integer
20244 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
20245 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20246
20247internal.htx.used : integer
20248 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
20249 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20250 direction.
20251
20252internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
20253 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20254 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
20255 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
20256 of the special value :
20257 * head : The oldest inserted block
20258 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020259 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020260
20261internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
20262 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20263 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
20264 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
20265 integer or one of the special value :
20266 * head : The oldest inserted block
20267 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020268 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020269
20270internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
20271 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20272 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
20273 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20274 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20275
20276 * head : The oldest inserted block
20277 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020278 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020279
20280internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
20281 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20282 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20283 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20284 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20285
20286 * head : The oldest inserted block
20287 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020288 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020289
20290internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
20291 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20292 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20293 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20294 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20295
20296 * head : The oldest inserted block
20297 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020298 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020299
20300internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
20301 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
20302 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
20303 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20304 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20305
20306 * head : The oldest inserted block
20307 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020308 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020309
20310internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
20311 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
20312 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
20313 it returns false.
20314
20315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200203167.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020317---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020318
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020319Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20320every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020321order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020322
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020323ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020324---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20325FALSE always_false never match
20326HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20327HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20328HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020329HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020330HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20331HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20332HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20333HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
20334LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
20335METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20336METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20337METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20338METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20339METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20340METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20341METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20342METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20343RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20344REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20345TRUE always_true always match
20346WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20347---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020348
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020349
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203508. Logging
20351----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020352
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020353One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20354provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20355very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20356provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20357state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020358to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020359headers.
20360
20361In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20362about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20363send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20364
20365 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20366 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20367 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20368 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20369 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020370 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020371 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020372
20373The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20374allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20375as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20376while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20377real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20378delay.
20379
20380
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203818.1. Log levels
20382---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020383
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020384TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020385source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020386HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20387in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20388track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20389syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20390about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020391
20392
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203938.2. Log formats
20394----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020395
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020396HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020397and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20398slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20399options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020400
20401 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20402 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20403 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20404 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20405 extents.
20406
20407 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20408 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20409 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20410 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20411 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20412
20413 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20414 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20415 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20416 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20417 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20418
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020419 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20420 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20421 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20422 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20423
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020424 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20425
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020426Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20427specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20428field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20429servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20430always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20431identifier.
20432
20433Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20434 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20435 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20436 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20437 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20438
20439
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204408.2.1. Default log format
20441-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020442
20443This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20444as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20445format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20446
20447 Example :
20448 listen www
20449 mode http
20450 log global
20451 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20452
20453 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20454 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20455 (www/HTTP)
20456
20457 Field Format Extract from the example above
20458 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20459 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20460 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20461 4 'to' to
20462 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20463 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20464
20465Detailed fields description :
20466 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20467 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20468 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20469 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20470 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20471 and processed the connection.
20472 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20473
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020474In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20475"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20476connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20477
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020478It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20479will eventually disappear.
20480
20481
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204828.2.2. TCP log format
20483---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020484
20485The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20486is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20487information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20488counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20489emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20490environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20491the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20492sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020493specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20494not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20495fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20496marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020497
20498 Example :
20499 frontend fnt
20500 mode tcp
20501 option tcplog
20502 log global
20503 default_backend bck
20504
20505 backend bck
20506 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20507
20508 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20509 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20510 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20511
20512 Field Format Extract from the example above
20513 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20514 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20515 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20516 4 frontend_name fnt
20517 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20518 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20519 7 bytes_read* 212
20520 8 termination_state --
20521 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20522 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20523
20524Detailed fields description :
20525 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020526 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020527 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20528 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020529 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020530 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020531 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020532
20533 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020534 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20535 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20536 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020537
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020538 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020539 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20540 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020541 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20542 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20543 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20544 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020545
20546 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20547 and processed the connection.
20548
20549 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20550 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20551 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20552 applications.
20553
20554 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20555 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20556 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20557 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20558 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20559
20560 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20561 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20562 See "Timers" below for more details.
20563
20564 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20565 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20566 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20567 "Timers" below for more details.
20568
20569 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020570 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020571 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20572 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20573 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20574 details.
20575
20576 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20577 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20578 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20579 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20580 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20581
20582 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20583 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20584 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20585 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20586 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20587 for more details.
20588
20589 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020590 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020591 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20592 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20593 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020594 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020595
20596 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20597 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20598 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20599 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20600 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20601 caused by a denial of service attack.
20602
20603 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20604 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20605 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20606 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20607 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20608 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20609 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20610 denial of service attack.
20611
20612 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20613 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20614 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20615 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20616 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20617 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20618 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20619 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20620 be processed than on other servers.
20621
20622 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20623 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20624 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20625 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020626 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020627 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20628 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20629 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20630 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20631 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20632 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20633 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20634 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20635
20636 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20637 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20638 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20639 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20640 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20641 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020642 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020643 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20644
20645 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20646 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20647 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20648 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20649 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20650 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020651 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020652 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20653 occurs.
20654
20655
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206568.2.3. HTTP log format
20657----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020658
20659The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20660is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20661the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20662are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20663emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20664generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20665"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20666which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020667frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20668is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020669
20670Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20671slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20672with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20673
20674 Example :
20675 frontend http-in
20676 mode http
20677 option httplog
20678 log global
20679 default_backend bck
20680
20681 backend static
20682 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20683
20684 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20685 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20686 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020687 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020688
20689 Field Format Extract from the example above
20690 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20691 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020692 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020693 4 frontend_name http-in
20694 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020695 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020696 7 status_code 200
20697 8 bytes_read* 2750
20698 9 captured_request_cookie -
20699 10 captured_response_cookie -
20700 11 termination_state ----
20701 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20702 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20703 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20704 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20705 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020706
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020707Detailed fields description :
20708 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020709 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020710 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20711 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020712 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020713 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020714 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020715
20716 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020717 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20718 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20719 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020720
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020721 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020722 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020723
20724 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20725 and processed the connection.
20726
20727 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20728 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20729 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20730
20731 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20732 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20733 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20734 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20735 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20736 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20737
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020738 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20739 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20740 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020741 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020742 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20743 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020744 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020745 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020746
20747 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20748 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020749 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020750
20751 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20752 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020753 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20754 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020755
20756 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20757 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20758 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20759 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20760 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020761 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20762 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020763
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020764 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020765 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20766 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20767 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20768 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20769 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20770 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020771 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020772
20773 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020774 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
20775 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020776
20777 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20778 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020779 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020780 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20781 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20782 overflowing.
20783
20784 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20785 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20786 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20787 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20788 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20789 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20790 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20791 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20792
20793 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20794 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20795 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20796 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20797 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20798 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20799 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20800 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20801
20802 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20803 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20804 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20805 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20806 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20807 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20808 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20809
20810 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020811 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020812 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20813 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20814 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020815 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020816 system.
20817
20818 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20819 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20820 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20821 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20822 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20823 caused by a denial of service attack.
20824
20825 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20826 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20827 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20828 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20829 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20830 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20831 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20832 denial of service attack.
20833
20834 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20835 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20836 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20837 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20838 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20839 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20840 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20841 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20842 processed than on other servers.
20843
20844 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20845 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20846 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20847 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020848 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020849 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20850 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20851 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20852 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20853 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20854 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20855 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20856 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20857
20858 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20859 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20860 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20861 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20862 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20863 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020864 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020865 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20866
20867 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20868 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20869 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20870 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20871 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20872 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020873 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020874 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20875 occurs.
20876
20877 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20878 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20879 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20880 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20881 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20882 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20883 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20884 cookies" below for more details.
20885
20886 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20887 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20888 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20889 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20890 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20891 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20892 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20893 and cookies" below for more details.
20894
20895 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20896 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20897 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20898 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20899 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20900 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20901 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20902 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20903
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020020904
209058.2.4. HTTPS log format
20906----------------------
20907
20908The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
20909extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
20910information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
20911frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
20912end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
20913matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
20914sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
20915dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
20916"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
20917
20918This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
20919appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
20920HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020921
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020020922 Example :
20923 frontend https-in
20924 mode http
20925 option httpslog
20926 log global
20927 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
20928 default_backend bck
20929
20930 backend static
20931 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
20932
20933 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20934 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
20935 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
20936 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0 TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
20937
20938 Field Format Extract from the example above
20939 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20940 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
20941 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
20942 4 frontend_name https-in
20943 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
20944 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
20945 7 status_code 200
20946 8 bytes_read* 2750
20947 9 captured_request_cookie -
20948 10 captured_response_cookie -
20949 11 termination_state ----
20950 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20951 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20952 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20953 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20954 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
William Lallemandfdc3faf2021-08-02 10:57:49 +020020955 17 fc_conn_err '/' ssl_fc_hsk_err '/' ssl_c_err '/' ssl_c_ca_err 0/0/0/0
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020020956 18 ssl_version '/' ssl_ciphers TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
20957
20958Detailed fields description :
William Lallemandfdc3faf2021-08-02 10:57:49 +020020959 - "fc_conn_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020020960 corresponds to the "fc_conn_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_conn_err" and
20961 "fc_conn_err_str" fetches for more information.
20962
20963 - "ssl_fc_hsk_err" is the status of the SSL handshake from the frontend's
20964 point of view. It will be 0 if everything went well. See the
20965 "ssl_fc_hsk_err" sample fetch's description for more information.
20966
20967 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
20968 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
20969 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
20970 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
20971
20972 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
20973 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
20974 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
20975 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
20976
20977 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
20978
20979 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
20980
20981
209828.2.5. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020983------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020984
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020985The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020986mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020987
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020988HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020989Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20990separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20991prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20992
20993Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20994variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020995("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020996
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020997If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020998as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020999less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
21000the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
21001
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020021002Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
21003"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
21004delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
21005preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021006
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021007Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
21008'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
21009https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
21010such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
21011
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021012Flags are :
21013 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021014 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021015 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
21016 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021017
21018 Example:
21019
21020 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
21021 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
21022
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021023 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
21024
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021025At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
21026
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021027 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21028 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021029
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021030the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021031
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021032 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
21033 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
21034 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021035
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021036the default HTTPS format is defined this way :
21037
21038 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21039 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
21040 %[fc_conn_err]/%[ssl_fc_hsk_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err] \
21041 %sslv/%sslc"
21042
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021043and the default TCP format is defined this way :
21044
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021045 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
21046 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021047
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021048Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
21049
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021050 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021051 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021052 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
21053 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
21054 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021055 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
21056 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
21057 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021058 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021059 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000021060 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000021061 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000021062 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021063 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
21064 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010021065 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020021066 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021067 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021068 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021069 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020021070 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080021071 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021072 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
21073 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
21074 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
21075 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
21076 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021077 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021078 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021079 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021080 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021081 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021082 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
21083 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021084 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21085 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
21086 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021087 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021088 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
21089 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021090 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021091 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21092 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
21093 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020021094 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020021095 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021096 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
21097 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
21098 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
21099 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020021100 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021101 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021102 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021103 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010021104 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021105 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021106 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
21107 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
21108 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021109 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021110 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
21111 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021112 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021113 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
21114 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020021115 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021116 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021117 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021118 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021119
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021120 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021121
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021122
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +0200211238.2.6. Error log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021124-----------------------
21125
21126When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021127protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021128By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
21129"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021130will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
William Lallemand56f1f752021-08-02 10:25:30 +020021131logged if the "dontlognull" option is set. If the "log-error-via-logformat" option
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4a6328f2021-07-29 09:45:53 +020021132is set, those messages are not emitted and a line following the configured
21133log-format is emitted instead.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021134
21135The format looks like this :
21136
21137 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
21138 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
21139 Connection error during SSL handshake
21140
21141 Field Format Extract from the example above
21142 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
21143 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
21144 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
21145 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
21146 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
21147
21148These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
21149failures.
21150
21151
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211528.3. Advanced logging options
21153-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021154
21155Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
21156just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
21157options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
21158for more information about their usage.
21159
21160
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211618.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
21162------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021163
21164It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021165HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021166commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
21167monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
21168ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
21169
21170 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
21171 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
21172 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
21173 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
21174
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020021175 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
21176 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021177
21178 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
21179 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
21180 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
21181
21182
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211838.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
21184----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021185
21186The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
21187what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
21188or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021189"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021190just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
21191log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
21192after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
21193is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
21194with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
21195with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
21196
21197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211988.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
21199------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021200
21201Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
21202for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
21203"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
21204retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
21205raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
21206a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
21207file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
21208you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
21209"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
21210
21211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212128.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
21213--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021214
21215Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
21216multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
21217them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
21218"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
21219logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
21220error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
21221and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
21222too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
21223useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
21224alternative.
21225
21226
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212278.4. Timing events
21228------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021229
21230Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
21231reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
21232the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
21233frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021234mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
21235addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
21236
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021237Timings events in HTTP mode:
21238
21239 first request 2nd request
21240 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
21241 t tr t tr ...
21242 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
21243 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
21244 :<---- Tq ---->: :
21245 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021246 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021247 :<--------- Ta --------->:
21248
21249Timings events in TCP mode:
21250
21251 TCP session
21252 |<----------------->|
21253 t t
21254 ---|----|----|----|----|---
21255 | Th Tw Tc Td |
21256 |<------ Tt ------->|
21257
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021258 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021259 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021260 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
21261 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
21262 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021263 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021264 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
21265 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
21266 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
21267 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021268
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021269 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
21270 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
21271 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021272 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
21273 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
21274 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
21275 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
21276 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
21277 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021278
21279 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
21280 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
21281 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
21282 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
21283 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
21284 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
21285 request typed by hand during a test.
21286
21287 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
21288 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021289 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021290 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
21291 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
21292 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
21293 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021294
21295 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
21296 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
21297 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
21298 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
21299 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
21300
21301 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
21302 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
21303 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
21304 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
21305 connection never established.
21306
21307 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
21308 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
21309 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
21310 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
21311 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
21312 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
21313 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
21314 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
21315 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
21316 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
21317 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
21318
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021319 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
21320 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
21321 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
21322 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
21323 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
21324 by subtracting other timers when valid :
21325
21326 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
21327
21328 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
21329 "Ta" can never be negative.
21330
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021331 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
21332 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021333 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
21334 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021335 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021336
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021337 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021338
21339 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021340 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
21341 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021342
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021343 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
21344 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
21345 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
21346 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
21347 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
21348 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
21349 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
21350 prefixed with a '+' sign.
21351
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021352These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
21353protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
21354that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021355due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
21356"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
21357that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021358
21359Most common cases :
21360
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021361 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
21362 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
21363 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
21364 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
21365 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021366 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021367 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
21368 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
21369 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
21370 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
21371 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020021372 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021373
21374 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
21375 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
21376 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
21377 of ms on remote networks.
21378
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021379 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
21380 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
21381 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021382
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021383 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
21384 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021385 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021386 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
21387 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
21388 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
21389 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
21390 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
21391 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021392
21393Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
21394
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021395 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021396 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021397 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021398
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021399 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021400 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
21401 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
21402
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021403 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021404 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
21405 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
21406 flags.
21407
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021408 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
21409 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021410 Check the session termination flags, then check the
21411 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21412 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21413 the client connection was maintained open.
21414
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021415 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021416 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021417 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021418 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21419
21420
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214218.5. Session state at disconnection
21422-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021423
21424TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21425"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
214262-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21427each of which has a special meaning :
21428
21429 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21430 session to terminate :
21431
21432 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21433
21434 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21435 server explicitly refused it.
21436
21437 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21438 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21439 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21440 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021441 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021442
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021443 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021444 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021445
21446 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21447 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21448 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21449 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21450 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21451
21452 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21453 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21454 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21455 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21456 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21457
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021458 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021459 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21460
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021461 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021462 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21463 backup connections when going up.
21464
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021465 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021466
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021467 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21468 send or receive data.
21469
21470 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21471 send or receive data.
21472
21473 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21474 with nothing left in the buffers.
21475
21476 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21477
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021478 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021479 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21480
21481 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21482 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21483 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21484 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21485 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21486
21487 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21488 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21489
21490 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21491 server (HTTP only).
21492
21493 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21494
21495 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21496 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21497 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21498
21499 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21500 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21501 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21502
21503 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21504
21505 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21506 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21507
21508 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21509 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21510 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21511
21512 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21513 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021514 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21515 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021516
21517 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21518 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21519 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21520 another server.
21521
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021522 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021523 server.
21524
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021525 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21526 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21527 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21528 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21529
21530 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21531 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21532 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21533 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21534
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021535 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21536 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21537 "use-server" rule).
21538
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021539 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21540
21541 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21542 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21543
21544 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21545
21546 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21547 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21548 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21549
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021550 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21551 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021552 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021553 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21554 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21555
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021556 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21557
21558 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21559 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21560
21561 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21562
21563 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21564
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021565The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21566was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021567helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21568starvation, attacks, etc...
21569
21570The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21571alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21572easier finding and understanding.
21573
21574 Flags Reason
21575
21576 -- Normal termination.
21577
21578 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021579 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21580 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021581 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21582
21583 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21584 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021585 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21586 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021587 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21588 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021589
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021590 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21591 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021592 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021593
21594 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21595 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21596 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21597
21598 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21599 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21600 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21601 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21602 the server takes too long to respond.
21603
21604 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21605 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21606 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21607 long a time to respond.
21608
21609 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21610 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21611 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021612 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021613 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21614 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021615
21616 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21617 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21618 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21619 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21620 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021621 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021622 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21623 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21624 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21625 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21626 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21627 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21628 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21629 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021630 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021631 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21632 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21633 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021634
21635 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21636 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021637 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21638 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21639 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21640 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021641
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021642 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021643 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21644
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021645 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021646 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21647 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021648 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021649 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21650 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21651
21652 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21653 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21654 503 or 504 here.
21655
21656 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021657 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021658 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21659 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21660 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21661
21662 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21663 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021664 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021665 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021666 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021667
21668 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21669 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21670 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21671 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21672 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21673 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021674 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021675
21676 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21677 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21678 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21679 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21680 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21681 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21682 solution is to fix the application.
21683
21684 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21685 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21686 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21687 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21688 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21689 external attacks.
21690
21691 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021692 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021693 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021694 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21695 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21696
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021697 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21698 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21699 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021700 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021701 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021702
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021703 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21704 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21705 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21706 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021707 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21708 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21709 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21710 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
21711 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021712
21713 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21714 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21715 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
21716 returned an HTTP 403 error.
21717
21718 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21719 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21720 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21721 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21722
21723 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21724 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21725 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21726 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21727
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021728The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021729persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021730important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21731re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21732
21733 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21734
21735 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21736 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21737 set on a GET request.
21738
21739 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21740 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021741 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021742 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21743
21744 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21745 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21746 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21747
21748 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21749 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21750 already got a cookie.
21751
21752 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21753 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21754 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21755 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21756 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21757
21758 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21759 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21760 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21761
21762 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21763 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21764 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21765
21766 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21767 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21768
21769 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21770 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21771 then advertised in the response.
21772
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021773
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217748.6. Non-printable characters
21775-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021776
21777In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21778consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21779converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21780prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21781being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21782escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21783is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21784'}' when logging headers.
21785
21786Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21787issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21788containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21789
21790Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21791the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21792performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21793
21794
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217958.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21796---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021797
21798Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21799achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021800section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021801cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21802the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21803the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021804locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021805not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21806user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21807a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21808wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21809
21810 Examples :
21811 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21812 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21813
21814 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21815 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21816
21817
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218188.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21819---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021820
21821Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21822proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21823the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21824server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21825
21826Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21827response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021828section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021829
21830It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021831time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21832appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021833are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21834and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21835follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21836request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21837in the logs.
21838
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021839As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21840frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21841an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21842
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021843 Example :
21844 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21845 listen proxy-out
21846 mode http
21847 option httplog
21848 option logasap
21849 log global
21850 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21851
21852 # log the name of the virtual server
21853 capture request header Host len 20
21854
21855 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21856 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21857
21858 # log the beginning of the referrer
21859 capture request header Referer len 20
21860
21861 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21862 capture response header Server len 20
21863
21864 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21865 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21866
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021867 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021868 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21869
21870 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21871 capture response header Via len 20
21872
21873 # log the URL location during a redirection
21874 capture response header Location len 20
21875
21876 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21877 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21878 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21879 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21880 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21881
21882 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21883 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21884 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21885 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021886 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021887
21888 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21889 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21890 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21891 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21892 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021893 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021894
21895
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218968.9. Examples of logs
21897---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021898
21899These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21900them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21901reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21902
21903 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21904 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21905 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21906
21907 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21908 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21909
21910 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21911 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21912 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21913
21914 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21915 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21916
21917 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21918 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21919 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21920
21921 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021922 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021923 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21924 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21925
21926 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21927 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21928 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21929
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021930 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21931 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21932 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21933 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021934 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021935 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021936
21937 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021938 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021939
21940 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21941 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21942 Nothing was sent to any server.
21943
21944 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21945 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21946
21947 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21948 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021949 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021950 send a 408 return code to the client.
21951
21952 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21953 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21954
21955 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21956 5 seconds ("c----").
21957
21958 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21959 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021960 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021961
21962 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021963 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021964 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21965 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21966 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21967 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21968 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021969
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021970
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200219719. Supported filters
21972--------------------
21973
21974Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21975accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21976unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21977
21978See also : "filter"
21979
219809.1. Trace
21981----------
21982
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021983filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021984
21985 Arguments:
21986 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21987 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21988
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021989 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021990
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021991 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021992 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21993 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21994 amount of the parsed data.
21995
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021996 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021997
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021998This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21999callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
22000information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
22001filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
22002
22003Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
22004tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
22005a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
22006
22007
220089.2. HTTP compression
22009---------------------
22010
22011filter compression
22012
22013The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
22014keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022015when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
22016fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
22017done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
22018explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
22019filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
22020listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22021order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022022
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022023See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
22024 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022025
22026
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200220279.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
22028--------------------------------------------
22029
22030filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
22031
22032 Arguments :
22033
22034 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
22035 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
22036 parsed.
22037
22038 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
22039 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
22040 part must be placed in its own scope.
22041
22042The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
22043external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022044streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022045exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
22046also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
22047
22048SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
22049the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
22050
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010022051For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022052"doc/SPOE.txt".
22053
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100220549.4. Cache
22055----------
22056
22057filter cache <name>
22058
22059 Arguments :
22060
22061 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
22062
22063The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
22064"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022065cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022066other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
22067case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
22068is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
22069filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010022070listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22071order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010022072
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022073See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
22074 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
22075
22076
220779.5. Fcgi-app
22078-------------
22079
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022080filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022081
22082 Arguments :
22083
22084 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
22085
22086The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
22087request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
22088reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
22089used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
22090implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
22091used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
22092fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
22093used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22094order.
22095
22096See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
22097 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
22098
22099
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100221009.6. OpenTracing
22101----------------
22102
22103The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
22104HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
22105of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
22106Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
22107
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022108This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022109
22110The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
22111HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
22112participates in the work of HAProxy.
22113
22114filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
22115
22116 Arguments :
22117
22118 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
22119 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
22120 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
22121 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
22122 OpenTracing filters.
22123
22124 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
22125 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
22126 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
22127 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
22128 filter must have its own scope defined.
22129
22130More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020022131of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022132
22133
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002213410. FastCGI applications
22135-------------------------
22136
22137HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
22138feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
22139the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
22140FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
22141servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
22142FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
22143backend.
22144
22145HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
22146application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
22147connection.
22148
2214910.1. Setup
22150-----------
22151
2215210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
22153--------------------------
22154
22155fcgi-app <name>
22156 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
22157 document root must be defined.
22158
22159acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
22160 Declare or complete an access list.
22161
22162 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
22163 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
22164 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
22165 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
22166 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
22167
22168docroot <path>
22169 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
22170 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
22171 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
22172
22173index <script-name>
22174 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
22175 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
22176 is an optional setting.
22177
22178 Example :
22179 index index.php
22180
22181log-stderr global
22182log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010022183 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022184 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
22185
22186 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
22187 default STDERR messages are ignored.
22188
22189pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22190 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
22191 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
22192 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22193
22194 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
22195 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
22196 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
22197 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
22198
22199 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
22200 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
22201
22202path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022203 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022204 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
22205 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
22206 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
22207 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
22208 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
22209 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
22210 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022211
22212 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022213 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022214 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
22215 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
22216 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
22217 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022218
22219 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022220 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
22221 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022222
22223option get-values
22224no option get-values
22225 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
22226
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022227 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022228 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
22229
22230 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
22231 application will accept.
22232
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020022233 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
22234 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022235
22236 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050022237 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022238 option is disabled.
22239
22240 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
22241 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
22242 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
22243 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
22244 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
22245 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
22246
22247option keep-conn
22248no option keep-conn
22249 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
22250 sending a response.
22251
22252 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
22253 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
22254
22255option max-reqs <reqs>
22256 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
22257 accept.
22258
22259 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
22260 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
22261 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
22262 to 1.
22263
22264option mpxs-conns
22265no option mpxs-conns
22266 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
22267
22268 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
22269 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
22270
22271set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22272 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
22273 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
22274 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
22275 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22276
22277 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
22278 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
22279 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
22280
22281 Example :
22282 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
22283 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
22284
22285 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
22286
22287
2228810.1.2. Proxy section
22289---------------------
22290
22291use-fcgi-app <name>
22292 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
22293
22294 Arguments :
22295 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
22296
22297 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
22298 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
22299 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
22300 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
22301 application may be defined at a time per backend.
22302
22303 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
22304 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
22305 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
22306 application are evaluated.
22307
22308
2230910.1.3. Example
22310---------------
22311
22312 frontend front-http
22313 mode http
22314 bind *:80
22315 bind *:
22316
22317 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
22318 default_backend back-static
22319
22320 backend back-static
22321 mode http
22322 server www A.B.C.D:80
22323
22324 backend back-dynamic
22325 mode http
22326 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
22327 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
22328
22329 fcgi-app php-fpm
22330 log-stderr global
22331 option keep-conn
22332
22333 docroot /var/www/my-app
22334 index index.php
22335 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
22336
22337
2233810.2. Default parameters
22339------------------------
22340
22341A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
22342the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022343script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022344applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
22345
22346 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22347 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
22348 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
22349 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
22350 | | |
22351 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22352 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
22353 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
22354 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
22355 | | application. |
22356 | | |
22357 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22358 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
22359 | | the request. It may not be set. |
22360 | | |
22361 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22362 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
22363 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
22364 | | the application's configuration. |
22365 | | |
22366 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22367 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
22368 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
22369 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
22370 | | |
22371 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22372 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
22373 | | following the part that identifies the script |
22374 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
22375 | | be defined. |
22376 | | |
22377 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22378 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
22379 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
22380 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
22381 | | is not set too. |
22382 | | |
22383 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22384 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
22385 | | set. |
22386 | | |
22387 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22388 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
22389 | | the request. |
22390 | | |
22391 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22392 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
22393 | | client as part of user authentication. |
22394 | | |
22395 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22396 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
22397 | | script to process the request. |
22398 | | |
22399 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22400 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
22401 | | |
22402 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22403 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
22404 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
22405 | | |
22406 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22407 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22408 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22409 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22410 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22411 | | |
22412 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22413 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22414 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22415 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22416 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22417 | | side. |
22418 | | |
22419 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22420 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22421 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22422 | | connected to. |
22423 | | |
22424 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22425 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22426 | | |
22427 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022428 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22429 | | current HAProxy version. |
22430 | | |
22431 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022432 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22433 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22434 | | |
22435 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22436
22437
2243810.3. Limitations
22439------------------
22440
22441The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22442way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22443during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22444establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22445application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22446or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22447message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22448these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22449and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22450
22451Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22452request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22453requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22454
22455About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22456into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22457fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22458"http-request" ones.
22459
22460Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22461FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22462processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22463must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22464here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022465
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022466
2246711. Address formats
22468-------------------
22469
22470Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22471address.
22472
22473This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22474The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22475of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22476equivalent is '::'.
22477
22478Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22479is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22480
22481This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22482family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22483
22484Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22485configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22486use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22487'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22488
22489Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22490socket type and the transport method.
22491
22492
2249311.1 Address family prefixes
22494----------------------------
22495
22496'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22497
22498'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22499 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22500 listening.
22501
22502'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22503 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22504 on the statement using this address, a port or
22505 a port range may or must be specified.
22506
22507'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22508 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22509 using this address, a port or a port range
22510 may or must be specified.
22511
22512'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22513 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22514 using this address, a port or a port range
22515 may or must be specified.
22516
22517'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22518 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22519 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22520 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22521 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22522 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22523
22524'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22525 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22526 start by slash '/'.
22527
22528
2252911.2 Socket type prefixes
22530-------------------------
22531
22532Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22533type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22534this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22535This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22536but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22537
22538Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
22539instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
22540
22541If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22542they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22543report this to the maintainers.
22544
22545'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22546 to "stream"
22547
22548'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22549 to "datagram".
22550
22551
2255211.3 Protocol prefixes
22553----------------------
22554
22555'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22556 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22557 socket type and transport method is forced to
22558 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22559 this address, a port or a port range can or
22560 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22561 of 'stream+ip@'.
22562
22563'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22564 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22565 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22566 statement using this address, a port or port
22567 range can or must be specified.
22568 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22569
22570'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22571 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22572 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22573 statement using this address, a port or port
22574 range can or must be specified.
22575 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22576
22577'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22578 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22579 socket type and transport method is forced to
22580 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22581 this address, a port or a port range can or
22582 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22583 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22584
22585'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22586 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22587 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22588 the statement using this address, a port or
22589 port range can or must be specified.
22590 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22591
22592'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22593 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22594 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22595 the statement using this address, a port or
22596 port range can or must be specified.
22597 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22598
22599'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22600 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22601 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22602
22603'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22604 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22605 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22606
22607In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22608QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22609
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022610/*
22611 * Local variables:
22612 * fill-column: 79
22613 * End:
22614 */